Table of Contents

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 10-K

 

þ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended February 28, 2010

 

OR

o TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

Commission file number 001-14669

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED

(Exact name of the registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Bermuda

74-2692550

(State or other jurisdiction of

(I.R.S. Employer

incorporation or organization)

Identification No.)

 

 

Clarenden House
Church Street
Hamilton, Bermuda

 

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

 

 

1 Helen of Troy Plaza

 

El Paso, Texas

79912

(Registrant’s United States Mailing Address)

(Zip Code)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (915) 225-8000

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

 

 

Common Shares, $.10 par value per share

 

The NASDAQ Global Select Market

 

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

NONE

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.                    Yes o No þ

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.                           Yes o No þ

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.                                                                                                                                                          Yes þ No o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).                                                                                                Yes o No o

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.                                                                                                                                                     o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company.  See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer o

 

Accelerated filer þ

 

Non-accelerated filer o

 

Smaller reporting company o

 

 

 

 

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

 

 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).                                    Yes o No þ

 

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of August 31, 2009, based upon the closing price of the common shares as reported by The NASDAQ Global Select Market on such date, was approximately $609,758,000.

 

As of May 10, 2010 there were 30,651,611 common shares, $.10 par value per share (“common stock”), outstanding.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

 

Certain information required for Part III of this annual report will be set forth in and incorporated herein by reference into Part III of this report from the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for the 2010 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders.

 



Table of Contents

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

 

 

 

PAGE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PART I

Item 1.

Business

 

3

 

 

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

 

12

 

 

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

 

21

 

 

Item 2.

Properties

 

22

 

 

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

 

23

 

 

Item 4.

Reserved

 

24

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PART II

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

25

 

 

Item 6.

Selected Financial Data

 

28

 

 

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

30

 

 

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

 

58

 

 

Item 8.

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

62

 

 

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

 

111

 

 

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

 

111

 

 

Item 9B.

Other Information

 

111

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PART III

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

 

112

 

 

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

 

112

 

 

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Shareholder Matters

 

112

 

 

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

 

112

 

 

Item 14.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

 

112

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PART IV

Item 15.

Exhibits,  Financial Statement Schedules

 

113

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Signatures

 

116

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1



Table of Contents

 

In this report and accompanying consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, unless the context suggests otherwise or otherwise indicated, references to “the Company”, “our Company”, “Helen of Troy”, “we”, “us” or “our” refer to Helen of Troy Limited and its subsidiaries, and amounts are expressed in thousands of U.S. Dollars.

 

INFORMATION REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

Certain written and oral statements made by our Company and subsidiaries of our Company may constitute “forward-looking statements” as defined under the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. This includes statements made in this report, in other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), in press releases, and in certain other oral and written presentations. Generally, the words “anticipates”, “believes”, “expects”, “plans”, “may”, “will”, “should”, “seeks”, “estimates”, “project”, “predict”, “potential”, “continue”, “intends” and other similar words identify forward-looking statements. All statements that address operating results, events or developments that we expect or anticipate will occur in the future, including statements related to sales, earnings per share results, and statements expressing general expectations about future operating results, are forward-looking statements and are based upon our current expectations and various assumptions. We believe there is a reasonable basis for our expectations and assumptions, but there can be no assurance that we will realize our expectations or that our assumptions will prove correct. Forward-looking statements are subject to risks that could cause them to differ materially from actual results.  Accordingly, we caution readers not to place undue reliance on forward-looking statements.  We believe that these risks include but are not limited to the risks described in this report under Item 1A., “Risk Factors” and that are otherwise described from time to time in our SEC reports filed after this report.  As described later in this report, such risks, uncertainties and other important factors include, among others:

 

·     the departure and recruitment of key personnel;

 

·     our ability to deliver products to our customers in a timely manner and according to their fulfillment standards;

 

·     our projections of product demand, sales and net income are highly subjective in nature and future sales and net income could vary in a material amount from such projections.

 

·     our relationship with key customers and licensors;

 

·     the costs of complying with the business demands and requirements of large sophisticated customers;

 

·     our dependence on foreign sources of supply and foreign manufacturing, and associated operational risks including but not limited to long lead times, consistent local labor availability and capacity, and timely availability of sufficient shipping carrier capacity;

 

·     the impact of changing costs of raw materials and energy on cost of goods sold and certain operating expenses;

 

·     the inability to liquidate auction rate securities;

 

·     circumstances which may contribute to future impairment of goodwill, intangible or other long-lived assets;

 

·     the risks associated with the use of trademarks licensed from third parties;

 

·     our dependence on the strength of retail economies and vulnerabilities to a prolonged economic downturn;

 

·     our ability to develop and introduce a continuing stream of new products to meet changing consumer preferences;

 

·     the potential impact of further disruptions in U.S. and international credit markets;

 

·     exchange rate risks;

 

·     expectations regarding future acquisitions and the integration of acquired businesses;

 

·     our use of debt and the constraints it may impose on our ability to operate our business;

 

·     the costs, complexity and challenges of managing our global information systems;

 

·     the risks associated with tax audits and related disputes with taxing authorities;

 

·     the risks of potential changes in laws, including tax laws and the complexities of compliance with such laws; and

 

·     our ability to continue to avoid classification as a controlled foreign corporation.

 

We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements as a result of new information, future events, or otherwise.

 

2



Table of Contents

 

PART I

 

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS

 

GENERAL

 

We are a global designer, developer, importer and distributor of an expanding portfolio of brand-name consumer products.  We were incorporated as Helen of Troy Corporation in Texas in 1968 and reincorporated as Helen of Troy Limited in Bermuda in 1994.  We have two segments: Personal Care and Housewares.  Our Personal Care segment’s products include hair dryers, straighteners, curling irons, hairsetters, shavers, mirrors, hot air brushes, home hair clippers and trimmers, paraffin baths, massage cushions, footbaths, body massagers, brushes, combs, hair accessories, liquid and aerosol hair care and styling products, men’s fragrances, men’s deodorants, liquid and bar soaps, shampoos, hair treatments, foot powder, body powder and skin care products. Our Housewares segment reports the operations of the OXO® (“OXO”) family of brands whose products include kitchen tools, cutlery, bar and wine accessories, household cleaning tools, food storage containers, tea kettles, trash cans, storage and organization products, hand tools, gardening tools, kitchen mitts and trivets, barbeque tools and rechargeable lighting products.   Both our Personal Care and Housewares segments sell their products primarily through mass merchandisers, drugstore chains, warehouse clubs, catalogs, grocery stores and specialty stores.  In addition, the Personal Care segment sells extensively through beauty supply retailers and wholesalers.

 

In each of our segments, we strive to be the first to market with a broad line of competitively priced innovative products.  We believe this strategy is one of our most important growth drivers.  Our goal is to provide consumers with unique features, better functionality and higher performance at competitive price points.  This strategy has allowed us to sustain, and in many categories to strengthen, our market position in many of our product lines.  As we extend our product lines and enter new product categories, we intend to expand our business in our existing customer base and attract new customers.

 

As part of our overarching objective to grow our business and increase shareholder value, we have established five core initiatives. These initiatives and their key elements are outlined below:

 

·                  Maximize high growth potential branded products.  We seek to maximize high growth products by selectively investing in consumer marketing propositions that we believe offer the best opportunities to capture market share and increase growth.  Ten key brands currently account for approximately 83 percent of our consolidated annual net sales revenue for fiscal year 2010.  When a brand fails to achieve a desired market potential, we evaluate whether to continue to invest in brand maintenance, exit the brand and/or selectively replace it with revenue streams from similar, more effectively performing branded products.

 

·                  Accelerate our new product pipeline.  We strive to reduce the time required to develop and introduce new products to meet changing consumer preferences and take advantage of opportunities sooner.  A majority of our products are produced in China, where long production lead times are normal.  We continuously work with our manufacturers to simplify and shorten the length of our supply chain for new products.

 

·                  Leverage innovation.  We constantly seek ways to foster our culture of innovation and new product development.  We intend to enhance and extend our existing product categories and develop new allied product categories to grow our business.  We believe new innovative products permit us to generate higher per unit sales prices and margins for us and the customers we serve, and increase the value of our brand base.  Examples of such new products are OXO’s recent launch of a new wet food storage line and a planned fiscal 2011 debut of the OXO Tot™ line of approximately 70 baby and toddler care products, including the Sprout™ convertible highchair, which requires no tools to adjust.

 

·                  Broaden our growth opportunities.  We plan to continue to seek opportunities to acquire brands and product categories through aggressive external development and acquisitions.  For example, on March 31, 2009, we acquired the Infusium 23® (“Infusium”) hair care products line from The Procter & Gamble Company.  Additionally on March 31, 2010, we acquired the Pert Plus® (“Pert Plus”) hair care and Sure®

 

3



Table of Contents

 

(“Sure”) anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC.   When brand acquisition is not possible, we look for licensed brands that have developed substantial brand equity in product categories that will create synergies with our existing products.  For example, our licensing of the Veet® brand in Europe, has given us the opportunity to provide epilation appliances styled and packaged for the European female consumer.

 

·                  Reduce cost and increase productivity.  We seek to control our expenses and strengthen operating margins by eliminating unnecessary spending, co-innovating with our manufacturers to eliminate costs, leveraging technology, and making productivity a key focus throughout our Company.

 

We present financial information by operating segment in Note (19) of our consolidated financial statements. The matters discussed in this Item 1. “Business,” pertain to all existing operating segments, unless otherwise specified.

 

LICENSES AND TRADEMARKS

 

We sell certain of our products under licenses from third parties.  Our licensed trademarks, among others, include:

 

·                  Vidal Sassoon®, licensed from The Procter & Gamble Company;

·                  Revlon®, licensed from Revlon Consumer Products Corporation;

·                  Dr. Scholl’s®, licensed from Schering-Plough HealthCare Products, Inc.;

·                  Scholl® (in areas other than North America), licensed from SSL International, PLC;

·                  Sunbeam® and Health o meter®, licensed from Sunbeam Products, Inc.;

·                  Sea Breeze®, licensed from Shiseido Company Ltd.;

·                  Vitapointe®, licensed from Sara Lee Household and Body Care UK Limited;

·                  Toni&Guy®, licensed from Mascolo Limited (in areas other than North and South America);

·                  Toni&Guy®, licensed form MBL/Toni&Guy Products LP (in North and South America);

·                  Bed Head® and TIGI® licensed from MBL/TIGI Products LP; and

·                  Veet®, licensed from Reckitt Benckiser Corporate Services Limited.

 

We own and market under a number of trademarks, including:

 

·  OXO®

·  Ammens®

·  Pro Beauty Tools™

·  Good Grips®

·  Ogilvie®

·  Caruso®

·  SoftWorks®

·  Final Net®

·  Karina®

·  OXO SteeL®

·  Vitalis®

·  Dazey®

·  Touchables®

·  Condition® 3-in-1

·  DCNL®

·  Candela®

·  SkinMilk®

·  Nandi®

·  Brut®

·  Epil-Stop®

·  Isobel®

·  Brut Revolution®

·  Salon Tools™

·  Carel®

·  Brut XT®

·  Studio Tools®

·  Amber Waves®

·  Infusium 23®

·  Hot Things®

 

 

We also own and market hair care and beauty care products under the following trademarks to the professional market:

 

· Helen of Troy®

· Curlmaster®

· Comare®

· Hot Tools®

· Pro Touch®

· Mega Hot®

· HotSpa®

· Tourmaline Tools®

· Shear Technology®

· Salon Edition®

· Fusion Tools®

· Hot Shot Tools®

· Belson®

· Ultra Tech®

· Brazilian Heat®

· Belson Pro®

· Wigo®

· Smart Heat®

· Gold ‘N Hot®

· Profiles Spa®

 

 

4



Table of Contents

 

During fiscal 2010, we began to earn royalties from the strategic brand licensing agreements with Staples Inc. (“Staples”), the world’s largest office products company, and UCB S.A. (“UCB”), a global biopharmaceutical leader.  Staples now sells an exclusive assortment of more than 30 OXO branded office products.  UCB offers patients suffering from rheumatoid arthritis and related conditions an OXO branded syringe that is ergonomically designed to simplify self injection.   While the Staples and UCB royalty revenue streams are not yet significant, we believe they have attractive long term growth potential and will add value to OXO’s brand equity by extending its reach into new consumer categories.

 

PRODUCTS

 

We market and sell a full line of personal care products and an expanding line of housewares products that we acquire, design and/or develop. The following table lists the primary products we sell and some of the brand names that appear on those products.

 

PRODUCT

 

 

CATEGORY

PRODUCTS

BRAND NAMES

Appliances and Accessories

Hand-held dryers

Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Bed Head®, Toni&Guy®, Sunbeam®, Helen of Troy®, Salon Edition®, Hot Tools®, Studio Tools®, Fusion Tools®, Ecostyle®, Tourmaline Tools®, Salon Tools™, Amber Waves®, Wigo®, Pro Beauty Tools™, Belson Pro®, Curlmaster®, Ultra Tech®, Gold ‘N Hot®, Mega Hot®, Pro Touch®, Profiles Spa®, Brazilian Heat®, Smart Heat®, Hot Shot Tools® and Salon Creations®

 

Curling irons, straightening irons, hot air brushes and brush irons

Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Bed Head®, Toni&Guy®, Sunbeam®, Helen of Troy®, Salon Edition®, Hot Tools®, Studio Tools®, Fusion Tools®, Ecostyle®, Tourmaline Tools®, Salon Tools™, Amber Waves®, Wigo®, Pro Beauty Tools™, Belson®, Belson Pro®, Curlmaster®, Ultra Tech®, Gold ‘N Hot®, Mega Hot®, Pro Touch®,  Brazilian Heat®, Smart Heat®,Hot Shot Tools® and Salon Creations®

 

Hairsetters

Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Bed Head®, Hot Tools®, Hot Shot Tools®, Sunbeam®, Caruso® and Profiles®

 

Paraffin baths, facial brushes, facial saunas and other skin care appliances

Revlon®, HotSpa®, Dr. Scholl’s® and Profiles®

 

Manicure/pedicure systems

Revlon®, Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl® and Profiles Spa®

 

Foot baths

Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Revlon®, Sunbeam®, Carel®, HotSpa® and Profiles Spa®

 

Foot, hydro, cushion, body and personal massagers and memory foam products

Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Health o meter®, Body Innovations™, Carel®, Profiles Spa® and HotSpa®

 

Hair clippers and trimmers, exfoliators, epilators and shavers

Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Bed Head®, Toni&Guy®, Hot Tools®, Brut®, Veet® and Belson Pro®

 

Hard and soft-bonnet hair dryers

Dazey®, Carel®, Hot Tools®, Amber Waves®, and Gold ‘N Hot®

 

Hair styling implements, brushes, combs, hand-held mirrors, lighted mirrors, utility implements and decorative hair accessories

Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Karina®, Isobel®, DCNL®, Nandi®, Amber Waves®, Wigo®, Hot Things®, Ecostyle®, Belson®, Gold ‘N Hot®, Comare®,  Brazilian Heat®, Hot Tools® and Shear Technology®

 

5



Table of Contents

 

PRODUCT

 

 

CATEGORY

PRODUCTS

BRAND NAMES

Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions

Liquid hair styling products, treatments and shampoos

Infusium 23®, Vitalis®, Final Net®, Condition® 3-in-1, Ogilvie®, Ammens® and Vitapointe®

Liquid and/or medicated skin care products

Sea Breeze®, Ammens® and SkinMilk®

 

Fragrances, deodorants and antiperspirants

Brut®, Brut Revolution®, Brut XT® and Ammens®

 

Hair depilatory products

Epil-Stop®

Housewares

Kitchen tools, cutlery, food storage containers, bar and wine accessories, kitchen mitts and trivets, and barbeque tools

OXO®, Good Grips®, OXO SteeL®, SoftWorks® and  Touchables®

 

Tea kettles

OXO®, Good Grips® and SoftWorks®

 

Household cleaning tools and trash cans

OXO®, OXO SteeL®, Good Grips®, SoftWorks® and Touchables®

 

Storage and organization products

OXO®, OXO SteeL®, Good Grips®, SoftWorks® and Touchables®

 

Hand and garden tools

OXO®, Good Grips® and SoftWorks®

 

Rechargeable lighting products

OXO® and Candela®

 

We continue to develop new products, respond to market innovations and enhance existing products with the objective of improving our position in the personal care and housewares markets. Overall, in fiscal 2010, we introduced 362 new products across all of our categories compared to 415 and 526 new products introduced in fiscal 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Currently, 389 additional new products are in our product development pipeline for expected introduction in fiscal 2011.   The following discussion summarizes key product introductions and strategies we launched in fiscal 2010.

 

Personal Care:  For our retail appliance customers, we continue to execute our strategy of being consumer centric and brand-driven. We have a strong portfolio of consumer brands which allow us to develop appropriate solutions for each consumer segment.  We introduced 255 new products in fiscal 2010 and expect to launch another 234 products for fiscal 2011 under such brand names as Revlon®, Vidal Sassoon®, Bed Head®, Pro Beauty Tools, Hot Tools®, Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Mega Hot®, Brazilian Heat®, Gold ‘N Hot® and Veet®. Our growth continues to be focused on innovation that is consumer relevant. Our research supports our understanding that consumers desire to express their personality through the tools they use every day. We recently addressed this need by launching a line of Revlon Designer Series products that feature sophisticated patterns in classic feminine colors. In addition, the Vidal Sassoon “Nano” line was launched featuring hair dryers and straighteners in three vibrant on-trend colors.  Under Revlon, we launched the “IT Styler” straightener featuring a unique plate design, which allows consumers to straighten, flip and curl their hair with one tool.   We also continue to tailor specific styling appliances to particular styling looks.  An example of this was the introduction of the Revlon Satin Straightener, featuring ceramic satin plates, which gives the consumer an extra smooth and silky finish.

 

In our personal care appliance business, we introduced new brands or sub-brands in fiscal 2010 with a combination of features, technology and pricing targeted to the needs of specific consumer segments. For example, we introduced the Pro Beauty Tools professional ceramic straightener into our retail sales channel at the end of fiscal 2010 and have developed a full line of Pro Beauty Tools professional appliances and brushes planned for introduction in the second quarter of fiscal 2011. Pro Beauty Tools are premium professional products incorporating our latest innovations and technology, but at a value proposition that we believe is not available in the retail market today.

 

Hot Tools® (“Hot Tools”) continues to be a preferred brand of styling tools in the professional beauty industry. Hot Tools Curling Irons were the first irons in the industry to use a specially designed electronic heating system for fast heatup and heat restoration. This patented Pulse Auto Heat Control® keeps the iron’s heat so stylists can work quickly and with consistent curl results. Hot Tools specialty irons provide stylists with a variety of tools to create a wide variety of special curl types that are popular in today’s hair fashions, along with select flat irons for straight sleek looks.  In fiscal 2010, we continued to enhance the visual appeal of our Hot Tools line with new packaging and designs released in our Nano Ceramic Black and White, Pink Titanium, Diamond Platinum and Blue Ice Titanium sub-lines.

 

6



Table of Contents

 

For professional appliances that are more ethnically focused, we continued to execute Belson business’s strategy with our emphasis on Smart Heat hair care appliances, which have settings optimized for specific hairstyles, and Brazilian Heat® (“Brazilian Heat”) for full-service distributors.  Brazilian Heat styling irons provide six heat settings up to 450 degrees and 30 second heat-up.  These irons give the stylist the ability to provide glossy, smooth styling for the finest straight hair to the coarsest curliest hair.

 

On March 31, 2009, we acquired the Infusium brand of shampoos and conditioners from The Procter & Gamble Company to add to our domestic grooming, skin care and hair care product line offerings. The line includes Infusium Leave-in Treatments, which feature essential pro-vitamins and other therapeutic ingredients for repairing and preventing hair damage.  Infusium offers outstanding product performance, strong consumer loyalty, distinctive positioning and has established a trusted reputation with stylists and consumers.  In Latin America, several new Ammens® Brand (“Ammens”) product introductions continued to lift the brand’s sales despite weak economic conditions.  For instance, in Mexico, we introduced Ammens medicated Chamomile and Aloe Vera based body powders and in Venezuela and Peru, we introduced the Ammens line of liquid hand soaps.  On March 31, 2010, we also acquired the Pert Plus hair care and Sure anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC.

 

Housewares:   Our OXO brand’s development pipeline continues to be strong, supporting OXO’s leadership in kitchen and household products. In fiscal 2010, we launched over 100 new items and currently have over 125 items scheduled for launch in fiscal 2011. Each was developed based on the principles of Universal Design, a philosophy of creating products that are easy to use for the widest possible spectrum of users.  This user-focused design has produced a portfolio of relevant, lasting products that have proven to be resistant to the impact of recessions.  During fiscal 2010, we expanded upon the success of the OXO POP line of modular dry food storage containers and launched the OXO TOP line of airtight wet food storage containers.

 

While OXO has been creating products for a broad base of users for 20 years, and we plan to expand our user base further to include young toddlers with the development of our OXO Tot™ line of products.  The OXO Tot™ products are developed to grow with a child for use over several years or stages of development.  All products are designed to be intuitive, easy to use and include features that improve performance.   We are targeting these products to be appealing aesthetically to children as well as their parents, many of whom are already loyal OXO consumers.  The suite of products, covering feeding, cleaning and bathing babies and toddlers, is scheduled to be available in the second half of fiscal 2011.   We also plan to launch our Good Grips® line of interlocking deep drawer plastic storage bins that we anticipate will begin to ship during the second half of fiscal 2011.

 

With each of these programs, OXO continues to expand its reach, bringing Universal Design and its mission to providing innovative consumer products that make everyday living easier into every area of the home.

 

You can learn more about our products at www.hotus.com.  Information contained on the Company’s website is not included as a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this report.

 

SALES AND MARKETING

 

We now market our products in approximately 74 countries throughout the world.  Sales within the United States comprised 79, 76 and 78 percent of total net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  We sell our products through mass merchandisers, drugstore chains, warehouse clubs, catalogs, grocery stores, specialty stores, beauty supply retailers, wholesalers and distributors, as well as directly to end-user consumers. We collaborate extensively with our retail customers and in many instances produce specific versions of our product lines with exclusive designs and packaging for their stores, which are appropriately priced for their respective customer bases.

 

We market products principally through the use of outside sales representatives and our own internal sales staff, supported by our internal marketing, category management, engineering, creative services and customer service staff.  These groups work closely together to develop pricing and distribution strategies, to design packaging, and to help develop product line extensions and new products.

 

7



Table of Contents

 

Regional sales and business unit managers work with our inside and outside sales representatives.  Our sales managers are organized by product group and geographic area and, in some cases, key customers.  Our regional managers are responsible for customer relations management, pricing, distribution strategies and sales generation.

 

The companies from whom we license many of our brand names promote those names extensively. The Revlon®, Vidal Sassoon®, Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Bed Head®, Veet®, Toni and Guy® and Sunbeam® trademarks are widely recognized because of advertising and the sale of a variety of products. We believe we benefit from the name recognition associated with a number of our licensed trademarks and seek to further improve the name recognition and perceived quality of all trademarks under which we sell products through our own advertising and product development efforts. We also promote our products through television advertising and through print media, including consumer and trade magazines, the internet and various industry trade shows.

 

MANUFACTURING AND DISTRIBUTION

 

We contract with unaffiliated manufacturers in the Far East, primarily in the Peoples’ Republic of China, to manufacture a significant portion of our products in the appliance, accessories and housewares product categories.  Most of our grooming, skin care and hair care solutions are manufactured in North America.  For a discussion regarding our dependency on third party manufacturers, see Item 1A., “Risk Factors.”  For fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, cost of goods sold manufactured by vendors in the Far East comprised approximately 85, 88 and 88 percent, respectively, of total consolidated cost of goods sold.  Our mix between Far East and domestic manufacturing changed in fiscal 2010 as grooming, skin care and hair care solutions became a larger part of our business.

 

Many of our key Far East manufacturers have been doing business with us since we went into business.  In some instances, we are now working with the second generation of entrepreneurs from the same families.  We believe these relationships give us a stable and sustainable advantage over many of our competitors.

 

Manufacturers who produce our products use formulas, molds, and certain other tooling, some of which we own, in manufacturing those products.  Both of our business segments employ numerous technical and quality control personnel responsible for ensuring high product quality.  Most of our products manufactured outside the countries in which they are sold are subject to import duties, which increase the amount we pay to obtain such products.

 

Our customers seek to minimize their inventory levels and often demand that we fulfill their orders within relatively short time frames. Consequently, our policy is to maintain several months of supply of inventory in order to meet our customers’ needs. Accordingly, we order products substantially in advance of the anticipated time of their sale to our customers. While we do not have any long-term formal arrangements with any of our suppliers, in most instances, we place purchase orders for products several months in advance of receipt of orders from our customers.  Our relationships and arrangements with most of our manufacturers allow for some flexibility in modifying the quantity, composition and delivery dates of orders.  Most purchase orders are in U.S. Dollars.  Because of our long lead times, from time to time, we must discount end of model product or sell it through closeout sales channels to eliminate excess inventories.

 

In total, we occupy approximately 1,960,000 square feet of distribution space in various locations to support our operations, which includes our 1,200,000 square foot Southhaven, Mississippi distribution center.  At the end of February 2007, we completed the consolidation of our domestic appliance, housewares, grooming, skin care and hair care inventories into our Southaven, Mississippi distribution center. Approximately 72 percent of our consolidated gross sales volume shipped from this facility in fiscal 2010.  For a further discussion of the risks associated with our distribution capabilities, see Item 1A., “Risk Factors.”   Products that are manufactured in the Far East and sold in North America are shipped to the West Coast of the United States and Canada. The products are then shipped by truck or rail service to distribution centers in El Paso, Texas; Southaven, Mississippi; and Toronto, Canada, or directly to customers. We ship substantially all products to North American customers from these distribution centers by ground transportation services. Products sold outside the United States and Canada are shipped from manufacturers, primarily in the Far East, to distribution centers in the Netherlands, the United Kingdom, Mexico, Peru, Venezuela, or directly to customers. We then ship products stored at these international distribution centers to distributors or retailers.

 

8



Table of Contents

 

LICENSE AGREEMENTS, TRADEMARKS, AND PATENTS

 

The Personal Care segment depends significantly upon the continued use of trademarks licensed under various agreements. The Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Sunbeam®, Health o meter®, Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Bed Head®, Toni&Guy®, Sea Breeze® and Veet® trademarks are of particular importance to this segment’s business. New product introductions under licensed trademarks require approval from the respective licensors. The licensors must also approve the product packaging. Many of our license agreements require us to pay minimum royalties, meet minimum sales volumes, and make minimum levels of advertising expenditures.  If we decide to renew these agreements upon expiration of their current terms, we will be required to pay prescribed renewal fees at the time of that election. The discussion below covers the primary product categories that we currently sell under our key license agreements. The product categories discussed do not necessarily include all of the products that Helen of Troy is entitled to sell under these or other license agreements.

 

Revlon®: Under agreements with the Revlon Consumer Products Corporation, we are licensed to sell worldwide, except in Western Europe, hair dryers, curling irons, straightening irons, brush irons, hairsetters, brushes, combs, mirrors, functional hair accessories, personal spa products, hair clippers and trimmers, and battery-operated and electric women’s shavers bearing the Revlon® trademark. These agreements have a remaining duration, including renewal terms, of approximately 53 years.

 

Vidal Sassoon®: Under an agreement with The Procter & Gamble Company, Helen of Troy is licensed to sell certain products bearing this trademark worldwide, except in Asia. Products sold under the terms of this license include hair dryers, curling irons, straightening irons, styling irons, hairsetters, hot air brushes, hair clippers and trimmers, mirrors, brushes, combs, and hair care accessories. This agreement has a remaining duration, including renewal terms, of approximately 23 years.

 

Sunbeam® and Health o meter®:   Under an agreement with Sunbeam Products, Inc., we are licensed to sell hair clippers and trimmers, hair dryers, curling irons, hairsetters, hot air brushes, mirrors, manicure kits, hair brushes and combs, hair rollers, hair accessories, paraffin baths, foot massagers, back massagers, body massagers, memory foam products, and spa products bearing these trademarks in the United States and Canada.  The Sunbeam Products Inc. license is currently scheduled to expire on December 31, 2012.

 

Dr. Scholl’s® and Scholl®:  We are licensed to sell foot baths, foot massagers, hydro massagers, cushion massagers, body massagers, paraffin baths, and support pillows bearing the Dr. Scholl’s® trademark in the United States and Canada under an agreement with Schering-Plough HealthCare Products, Inc. We also are licensed to sell the same products under the Scholl® trademark in other areas of the world through an agreement with SSL International, PLC. These agreements have a remaining duration, including renewal terms, of approximately 10 years.

 

Toni&Guy® and Bed Head®: Under an agreement with Mascolo Limited, we are licensed to sell hair care and grooming appliances under the Toni&Guy® trademark in Western Europe and portions of Asia.  The initial term of the license agreement expires in March 2011, and may be extended an additional two years upon proper notice.  In December 2006, we also entered into separate licensing arrangements with Mascolo Limited, MBL/Toni&Guy Products LP and MBL/TIGI Products LP for the use of the Bed Head® by TIGI and Toni&Guy® trademarks.  The licenses grant us the right to use the trademarks to market personal care products in the Western Hemisphere.  The initial term of each license agreement expires in December 2011, and may be extended for five additional three-year terms upon proper notice.

 

Sea Breeze®: We license the right to sell products in the United States, Canada, and the Caribbean under this trademark pursuant to a perpetual royalty free license from Shiseido Company Ltd.  We currently sell a line of liquid skin care products under this name in the United States and Canada.

 

Veet®:  We license the right to sell women’s hair removal appliances in the United States, Canada, Mexico, Europe and the Middle East under this trademark pursuant to a license from Reckitt Benckiser Corporate Services Limited.  The license agreement for Europe and the Middle East is currently scheduled to expire on September 30, 2012 while the license agreement for United States, Canada and Mexico is currently scheduled to expire on December 31, 2013.

 

9



Table of Contents

 

Helen of Troy has filed or obtained licenses for over 500 design and utility patents in the United States and several foreign countries.  Most of these patents cover product designs in our Housewares segment, and over two-thirds of these are utility patents.  We believe the loss of the protection afforded by any one of these patents would not have a material adverse effect on our business as a whole.  We also protect certain details about our processes, products and strategies as trade secrets, keeping confidential the information that we believe provides us with a competitive advantage.  We believe our principal trademarks have high levels of brand name recognition among retailers and consumers throughout the world. In addition, we believe our brands have an established reputation for quality, reliability and value.  We monitor and protect our brands against infringement, as we deem appropriate, however, our ability to enforce patents, copyrights, licenses, and other intellectual property is subject to general litigation risks, as well as uncertainty as to the enforceability of various intellectual property rights in various jurisdictions.

 

CUSTOMERS

 

Sales to Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. (including its affiliates) accounted for approximately 18, 17 and 19 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.   Sales to our second largest customer, Bed Bath and Beyond, Inc., all within the United States and Canada, accounted for approximately 10, 8 and 8 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  No other customers accounted for ten percent or more of net sales revenue during those fiscal years.  Sales to our top five customers accounted for approximately 46, 43 and 44 percent in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

ORDER BACKLOG

 

When placing orders, our retail and wholesale customers usually request that we ship the related products within a short time frame.  As such, there usually is no significant backlog of orders in any of our distribution channels.

 

COMPETITIVE CONDITIONS

 

The markets in which we sell our products are very competitive and highly mature.  The rapid growth of large mass merchandisers, together with changes in consumer shopping patterns, have contributed to a significant consolidation of the consumer products retail industry and the formation of dominant multi-category retailers with strong negotiating power.  Current trends among retailers include fostering high levels of competition among suppliers, the requirement to maintain or reduce prices and deliver products under shorter lead times.  Additionally, certain retailers source and sell products under their own private label brands that compete with our Company’s products.  We believe that we have certain key competitive advantages, such as well recognized brands, engineering expertise and innovation, sourcing and supply chain know-how, and productive co-development relationships with our Far East manufacturers, some of which have been built over 30 years or more of working together. We believe these advantages allow us to bring our retailers a value proposition in our products that can significantly out-perform private label products.  Maintaining and gaining market share depends heavily on product development and enhancement, pricing, quality, performance, packaging and availability, brand name recognition, patents, and marketing and distribution approaches.

 

In the Personal Care segment, our primary competitors include Conair Corporation, Farouk Systems, Inc. (Chi), T3 Micro, Inc., International Consulting Associates, Inc. (InfraShine), FHI Heat, Inc., Jamella Limited (GHD), The Cricket Company LLC, Turbo Ion, Inc. (Croc Hair Products), Spectrum Brands, Inc., Goody Products, Inc., a division of Newell Rubbermaid, Inc., Homedics-U.S.A, Inc., Chattem, Inc., KAO Brands Company, The Procter & Gamble Company, L'Oréal Group, Unilever N.V., the Alberto-Culver Company, Colgate-Palmolive Company, Beirsdorf AG and Coty Inc.  In the Housewares segment, the competition is highly fragmented.  Our primary competitors in that segment include Lifetime Brands, Inc. (KitchenAid), Zyliss AG, Wilton Industries, Inc. (Copco), Simplehuman LLC,  Casabella Holdings LLC and Interdesign, Inc.  Some of these competitors have significantly greater financial and other resources than we do.

 

10


 


Table of Contents

 

SEASONALITY

 

Our business is somewhat seasonal. Net sales revenue in the third fiscal quarter accounted for approximately 29, 30 and 32 percent of fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008 net sales revenue, respectively. Our lowest net sales revenue usually occurs in our first fiscal quarter, which accounted for approximately 22, 23 and 22 percent of fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008 net sales revenue, respectively.  As a result of the seasonality of sales, our working capital needs fluctuate during the year.

 

GOVERNMENTAL REGULATION AND ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS

 

Our operations are subject to national, state, local and provincial jurisdictions’ environmental and health and safety laws and regulations.  These laws and regulations impose workplace standards and regulate the discharge of pollutants into the environment.  In addition, they establish various standards for the handling, generation, emission, release, discharge, treatment, storage and disposal of materials and substances including solid and hazardous wastes.

 

Many of the products we sell are subject to a number of product safety laws and regulations in various jurisdictions.  These laws and regulations specify the maximum allowable levels of certain materials that may be contained in our products, provide statutory prohibitions against misbranded and adulterated products, establish ingredients and manufacturing procedures for certain products, specify product safety testing requirements and set product identification and labeling requirements.

 

We believe that we are in material compliance with these laws and regulations. Further, the cost of maintaining compliance has not had a material adverse effect on our business, consolidated results of operations and consolidated financial condition, nor do we expect it to do so in the foreseeable future.  Due to the nature of our operations and the frequently changing nature of environmental compliance standards and technology, we cannot predict with any certainty that future material capital or operating expenditures will not be required in order to comply with all applicable environmental laws and regulations.

 

EMPLOYEES

 

As of fiscal year end 2010, we employed 877 full-time employees in the United States, Canada, Macao, China, Japan, the United Kingdom, France, Peru, Venezuela, Chile, Costa Rica and Mexico of which 171 are marketing and sales employees, 237 are distribution employees, 41 are engineering and development employees, and 428 are administrative personnel. We also use temporary, part time and seasonal employees as needed.  None of the Company’s employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement.  We have never experienced a work stoppage and we believe that we have satisfactory working relations with our employees.

 

GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION

 

Note (19) to our consolidated financial statements contains geographic information concerning our net sales revenue and long-lived assets.

 

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

 

We maintain our main Internet site at the following address: http://www.hotus.com. The information contained on this website is not included as a part of, or incorporated by reference into, this report.  We make available on or through our main website’s Investor Relations page under the heading “SEC Filings” certain reports and amendments to those reports that we file with, or furnish to the SEC in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “ Exchange Act”). These include our annual reports on Form 10-K, our quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, our current reports on Form 8-K, our proxy statements on Schedule 14A, amendments to these reports, and the reports required under Section 16 of the Exchange Act of transactions in Company shares by directors and officers.  We make this information available on our website free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file the information with, or furnish it to, the SEC.  Also, on the Investor Relations page, under the heading “Corporate Governance,” are the Company’s Code of Ethics, Corporate Governance Guidelines and the Charters of the Committees of the Board of Directors.

 

11



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS

 

The ownership of our common stock involves a number of risks and uncertainties.  When evaluating us and our business before making a decision regarding investment in our securities, potential investors should carefully consider the risk factors and uncertainties described below, together with other information contained in this report.  If any of the events or circumstances described below or elsewhere in this report actually occur, they could adversely effect our business and operating results.  The risks listed below are not the only risks that we face.  Additional risks that are presently unknown to us or that we currently think are not significant may also impact our business operations.

 

We rely on our chief executive officer and a small number of other key senior managers to operate our business. The loss of any of these individuals could have a material adverse effect on our business.

 

We do not have a large group of senior managers in our business.  The loss of our chief executive officer or any of our senior managers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations, particularly if we are unable to hire or relocate and integrate suitable replacements on a timely basis or at all.  Further, in order to continue to grow our business, we will need to expand our senior management team.  We may be unable to attract or retain these persons.  This could hinder our ability to grow our business and could disrupt our operations or otherwise have a material adverse effect on our business.

 

Our ability to deliver products to our customers in a timely manner and to satisfy our customers’ fulfillment standards are subject to several factors, some of which are beyond our control.

 

Retailers place great emphasis on timely delivery of our products for specific selling seasons, especially during our third fiscal quarter, and on the fulfillment of consumer demand throughout the year. We cannot control all of the various factors that might affect product delivery to retailers. Vendor production delays, difficulties encountered in shipping from overseas as well as customs clearance are on-going risks of our business. We also rely upon third-party carriers for our product shipments from our distribution centers to customers, and we rely on the shipping arrangements our suppliers have made in the case of products shipped directly to retailers from the suppliers. Accordingly, we are subject to risks, including labor disputes, inclement weather, natural disasters, possible acts of terrorism, availability of shipping containers, and increased security restrictions associated with such carriers’ ability to provide delivery services to meet our shipping needs.  Failure to deliver products to our retailers in a timely and effective manner, often under special vendor requirements to use specific carriers and delivery schedules, could damage our reputation and brands and result in loss of customers or reduced orders.

 

To make our distribution operations more efficient, we have consolidated many of our U.S. distribution, receiving and storage functions into our Southaven, Mississippi distribution center. Approximately 72 percent of our consolidated gross sales volume shipped from this facility in fiscal 2010.  For this reason, any disruption in our distribution process in this facility, even for a few days, could adversely effect our business and operating results.

 

Additionally, our Mississippi distribution center operations have grown to a level where we may incur capacity constraints during peak shipping periods, should we continue to grow our sales revenue either through organic growth or  acquisitions.  These and other factors described above could cause delays in the delivery of our products and increases in shipping and storage costs that could have a material and adverse effect on our business and operating results.

 

Our projections of product demand, sales and net income are highly subjective in nature and our future sales and net income could vary in a material amount from our projections.

 

Most of our major customers purchase our products electronically through electronic data interchange and expect prompt delivery of products from our existing inventories to the customers’ retail stores or distribution centers.  This method of ordering products allows our customers to respond quickly to changes in demands of their retail customers.  From time to time, we may provide projections to our shareholders, lenders, investment community, and other stakeholders of our future sales and net income.  Since we do not require long-term purchase commitments from our major customers and the customer order and ship process is very short, it is difficult for us to accurately predict the demand for many of our products, or the amount and timing of our future sales and related net income.  Our projections

 

12



Table of Contents

 

are based on management’s best estimate of sales using historical sales data and other information deemed relevant.  These projections are highly subjective since sales to our customers can fluctuate substantially based on the demands of their retail customers and due to other risks described in this report. Additionally, changes in retailer inventory management strategies could make our inventory management more difficult. Because our ability to forecast product demand and the timing of related sales includes significant subjective input, there is a risk that our future sales and net income could vary materially from our projections.

 

Our results of operations are dependent on sales to several large customers and the loss of, or substantial decline in, sales to a top customer could have a material adverse effect on our revenues and profitability.

 

A few customers account for a substantial percentage of our net sales revenue.  Our financial condition and results of operations could suffer if we lost all or a portion of the sales to these customers.  In particular, sales to our largest customer accounted for approximately 18 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010. Sales to our second largest customer, all within the U.S. and Canada, accounted for approximately 10 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010.  While only two customers accounted for 10 percent or more of net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, our top five customers accounted for approximately 46 percent of fiscal 2010 net sales revenue.  We expect that a small group of customers will continue to account for a significant portion of our net sales revenue.  Although we have long-standing relationships with our major customers, we generally do not have written agreements that require these customers to buy from us or to purchase a minimum amount of our products.  A substantial decrease in sales to any of our major customers could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

With the growing trend towards retail trade consolidation, we are increasingly dependent upon key customers whose bargaining strength is substantial and growing. We may be negatively affected by changes in the policies of our customers, such as on-hand inventory reductions, limitations on access to shelf space, use of private label brands, price demands and other conditions, which could negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

 

A significant deterioration in the financial condition of our major customers could have a material adverse effect on our sales and profitability. We regularly monitor and evaluate the credit status of our customers and attempt to adjust sales terms as appropriate.  Despite these efforts, a bankruptcy filing by a key customer could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.  For further information regarding the impact of such issues with a significant customer that ceased operations in fiscal 2009, see Note (2) to our consolidated financial statements.

 

Large sophisticated customers may take actions that adversely affect our gross profit and results of operations.

 

In recent years, we have observed a consumer trend away from traditional grocery and drugstore channels and toward mass merchandisers, which include super centers and club stores.  This trend has resulted in the increased size and influence of these mass merchandisers. Additionally, these mass merchandisers source and sell products under their own private label brands that compete with our Company’s products.  As mass merchandisers grow larger and become more sophisticated, they may demand lower pricing, special packaging, shorter lead times for the delivery of products, or impose other requirements on product suppliers.  These business demands may relate to inventory practices, logistics, or other aspects of the customer-supplier relationship.  If we do not effectively respond to the demands of these mass merchandisers, they could decrease their purchases from us.  A reduction in the demand of our products by these mass merchandisers and the costs of complying with customer business demands could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

 

13



Table of Contents

 

We are dependent on third party manufacturers, most of which are located in the Far East, and any inability to obtain products from such manufacturers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

All of our products are manufactured by unaffiliated companies, most of which are in the Far East, principally in China.  This exposes us to risks associated with doing business globally, including: changing international political relations; labor availability and cost; changes in laws, including tax laws, regulations and treaties; changes in labor laws, regulations, and policies; changes in customs duties and other trade barriers; changes in shipping costs; currency exchange fluctuations; local political unrest; an extended and complex transportation cycle; the impact of changing economic conditions; and the availability and cost of raw materials and merchandise.  The political, legal and cultural environment in the Far East is rapidly evolving, and any change that impairs our ability to obtain products from manufacturers in that region, or to obtain products at marketable rates, could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

With most of our manufacturers located in the Far East, our production lead times are relatively long. Therefore, we must commit to production in advance of customer orders. If we fail to forecast customer or consumer demand accurately, we may encounter difficulties in filling customer orders on a timely basis or in liquidating excess inventories. We may also find that customers are canceling orders or returning products.  Another recent development affecting most companies importing goods from China is that it has become increasingly difficult to secure cargo capacity on a timely basis and at contracted prices.  We believe this may signal a trend of higher ocean freight transportation prices in fiscal 2011.  Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Historically, labor in China has been readily available at relatively low cost as compared to labor costs in North America.  China has experienced rapid social, political and economic change in recent years. There is no assurance labor will continue to be available in China at costs consistent with historical levels or that changes in labor or other laws will not be enacted which would have a material adverse effect on product costs in China.  Many of our suppliers are currently dealing with labor shortages in China which may result in future supply delays and disruptions and drive a substantial increase in labor costs.  Similarly, evolving government labor regulations and associated compliance standards could cause our product costs to rise or could cause manufacturing partners we rely on to exit the business.  This could have an adverse impact on product availability and quality.  The Chinese economy has experienced rapid expansion and highly fluctuating rates of inflation.  Higher general inflation rates will require manufacturers to continue to seek increased product prices.  During fiscal 2010, the Chinese Renminbi remained relatively stable against the U.S. Dollar.  During fiscal 2009 and 2008, the Chinese Renminbi appreciated approximately 4 percent and 9 percent, respectively, against the U.S. Dollar.  To the extent the Chinese Renminbi appreciates with respect to the U.S. Dollar in the future, the Company may experience cost increases on such purchases, and this could adversely impact profitability. China has suggested that it may move its currency off a peg to the U.S. dollar, which could result in an appreciation move and increase our product costs over time.  The Company may not be successful at implementing customer pricing or other actions in an effort to mitigate the related effects of the product cost increases.  Although China currently enjoys “most favored nation” trading status with the U.S., the U.S. government has in the past proposed to revoke such status and to impose higher tariffs on products imported from China. There is no assurance that our business will not be affected by any of the aforementioned risks, each of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

14



Table of Contents

 

High costs of raw materials and energy may result in increased cost of goods sold and certain operating expenses and adversely affect our results of operations and cash flow.

 

Significant variations in the costs and availability of raw materials and energy may negatively affect our results of operations.  Our suppliers purchase significant amounts of metals and plastics to manufacture our products. In addition, they also purchase significant amounts of electricity to supply the energy required in their production processes.  Changes in the cost of fuel have corresponding impacts to our transportation costs.  The cost of these raw materials and energy, in the aggregate, represents a significant portion of our cost of goods sold and certain operating expenses.  Our results of operations could be adversely affected by future increases in these costs.  We have had some success in implementing price increases to our customers or passing on product cost increases by moving customers to newer product models with enhancements that justify higher prices and we intend to continue these efforts.  We can make no assurances that these efforts will be successful in the future or will materially offset the cost increases we may incur.

 

We hold certain auction rate securities that we may be unable to liquidate at their recorded values or at all due to credit concerns in the U.S. capital markets.  Protracted illiquidity and any deterioration in the credit ratings of the issuers, dealers or credit insurers may require us to record other-than-temporary impairment charges.

 

We hold investments in auction rate securities (“ARS”) collateralized by student loans (with underlying maturities from 19 to 36 years).  At February 28, 2010, 97 percent of the aggregate collateral was guaranteed by the U.S. government under the Federal Family Education Loan Program.  Liquidity for these securities was normally dependent on an auction process that resets the applicable interest rate at pre-determined intervals, ranging from 7 to 35 days.  Beginning in February 2008, the auctions for the ARS held by us and others were unsuccessful, requiring us to hold them beyond their typical auction reset dates. Auctions fail when there is insufficient demand.  However, this does not represent a default by the issuer of the security. Upon an auction’s failure, the interest rates reset based on a formula contained in the security.  The securities will continue to accrue interest and be auctioned until one of the following occurs: the auction succeeds; the issuer calls the securities; or the securities mature.

 

Conditions in the capital markets have significantly reduced our ability to liquidate our ARS.  At this time, there is a very limited demand for the securities we continue to hold and limited acceptable alternatives to liquidate such securities.  Based on current market conditions, we believe it is likely that auctions of our holdings in these securities will be unsuccessful in the near term, resulting in us continuing to hold securities beyond their next scheduled auction reset dates and limiting the short-term liquidity of these investments.  Management intends to continue to reduce our holdings in these securities as circumstances allow, but believes there is sufficient liquidity from operating cash flows and available financial sources, including our revolving credit facility, which we believe will continue to provide sufficient capital resources to fund our foreseeable short and long-term liquidity requirements.

 

During the quarter ended August 31, 2008, we developed a series of discounted cash flow models and began using them to value our ARS.   Some of the inputs into the discounted cash flow models we use are unobservable in the market and have a significant effect on valuation.  These inputs attempt to capture the impact of illiquidity on the investments and have resulted in the recording of unrealized losses on the ARS.  The recording of these unrealized losses is not a result of the quality of the underlying collateral, but rather a markdown reflecting a lack of liquidity and other market conditions.  If the issuers’ credit ratings or other market conditions deteriorate, the Company may be required to record other-than-temporary impairment charges on these investments in the future, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.  For further information on our ARS, see Notes (1), (10), (11) and (16) to our consolidated financial statements.

 

15



Table of Contents

 

If our goodwill, indefinite-lived intangible assets or other long-term assets become impaired, we will be required to record additional impairment charges, which may be significant.

 

A significant portion of our long-term assets continues to consist of goodwill and other indefinite-lived intangible assets recorded as a result of past acquisitions.  We do not amortize goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets, but rather review them for impairment on an annual basis or more frequently whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying value may not be recoverable.   We consider whether circumstances or conditions exist which suggest that the carrying value of our goodwill and other long-lived assets might be impaired. If such circumstances or conditions exist, further steps are required in order to determine whether the carrying value of each of the individual assets exceeds its fair market value. If analysis indicates that an individual asset’s carrying value does exceed its fair market value, the next step is to record a loss equal to the excess of the individual asset’s carrying value over its fair value. The steps required by U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) entail significant amounts of judgment and subjectivity.

 

We complete our analysis of the carrying value of our goodwill and other intangible assets during the first quarter of each fiscal year, or more frequently whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate their carrying value may not be recoverable.  Events and changes in circumstances that may indicate there is impairment and which may indicate interim impairment testing is necessary include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions to exit a business or dispose of an asset made in response to changes in economic, political and competitive conditions, the impact of the economic environment on our customer base and on broad market conditions that drive valuation considerations by market participants, our internal expectations with regard to future revenue growth and the assumptions we make when performing our impairment reviews, a significant decrease in the market price of our assets, a significant adverse change in the extent or manner in which our assets are used, a significant adverse change in legal factors or the business climate that could affect our assets, an accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition of an asset, and significant changes in the cash flows associated with an asset.  We analyze these assets at the individual asset, reporting unit and Company levels. As a result of such circumstances, we may be required to record a significant charge to net income in our financial statements during the period in which any impairment of our goodwill, indefinite-lived intangible assets or other long-term assets is determined.  Any such impairment charges could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

 

For example, as a result of the continued deterioration of economic conditions during the second half of fiscal 2009, the Company evaluated the impact of these conditions and other developments on its reporting units to assess whether impairment indicators were present that would require interim impairment testing. As a result of our impairment testing as of February 28, 2009, we recorded impairment charges totaling $99.51 million ($99.06 million after tax) in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  For additional information, see the discussion under Notes (1) and (4) to our consolidated financial statements and in “Results of Operations” under Item 7., “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

 

We rely on licensed trademarks, the loss of which could have a material adverse effect on our revenues and profitability.

 

We are materially dependent on our licensed trademarks as a substantial portion of our sales revenue comes from selling products under licensed trademarks. As a result, we are materially dependent upon the continued use of such trademarks, particularly the Vidal Sassoon® and Revlon® trademarks. Actions taken by licensors and other third parties could diminish greatly the value of any of our licensed trademarks. If we were unable to sell products under these licensed trademarks or the value of the trademarks were diminished by the licensor due to any inability to perform under the terms of the agreements or other reasons, or due to the actions of third parties, the effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations could be both negative and material.

 

16



Table of Contents

 

We are subject to risks related to our dependence on the strength of retail economies and may be vulnerable in the event of a prolonged economic downturn.

 

Our business depends on the strength of the retail economies in various parts of the world, primarily in North America and to a lesser extent Europe and Latin America. These retail economies are affected primarily by factors such as consumer demand and the condition of the retail industry, which, in turn, are affected by general economic conditions and specific events such as natural disasters, terrorist attacks and political unrest.  Consumer spending in any geographic region is generally affected by a number of factors, including local economic conditions, government actions, inflation, interest rates, energy costs, gasoline prices and consumer confidence generally, all of which are beyond our control.  Consumer purchases of discretionary items tend to decline during recessionary periods, when disposable income is lower, and may impact sales of our products. As a result of the global recession, consumers may have less money for discretionary purchases as a result of job losses, foreclosures, bankruptcies, reduced access to credit, and sharply falling asset prices, among other things.  A prolonged economic downturn or recession in the United States, United Kingdom, Canada, Mexico or any of the other countries in which we conduct significant business may cause significant readjustments in both the volume and mix of our product sales, which could materially and adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The impact of these external factors and the extent to which they may continue is difficult to predict, and one or more of the factors could adversely impact our business. In recent years, the retail industry in the U.S. and, increasingly elsewhere, has been characterized by intense competition among retailers. Because such competition, particularly in weak retail economies, can cause retailers to struggle or fail, we must continuously monitor, and adapt to changes in, the profitability, creditworthiness and pricing policies of our customers.  A continued weakening of retail economies, as we have seen during fiscal 2009 and 2010, could continue to have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

To compete successfully, we must develop and introduce a continuing stream of innovative new products to meet changing consumer preferences.

 

Our long-term success in the competitive retail environment depends on our ability to develop and commercialize a continuing stream of innovative new products that meet changing consumer preferences and take advantage of opportunities sooner than our competition. We face the risk that our competitors will introduce innovative new products that compete with our products. Our core initiatives include fostering our culture of innovation and new product development, enhancing and extending our existing product categories and developing new allied product categories.  There are numerous uncertainties inherent in successfully developing and commercializing new products on a continuing basis and new product launches may not deliver expected growth in sales or operating income.   If we are unable to develop and introduce a continuing stream of new products, it may have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Further disruptions in U.S. and international credit markets may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Disruptions in national and international credit markets have led to limitations on credit availability, tighter lending standards, higher interest rates on consumer and business loans, and higher fees associated with obtaining and maintaining credit availability.  Additional and continued disruptions may materially limit consumer credit availability and restrict credit availability to our customer base and the Company.

 

Effective December 15, 2008, we amended our revolving credit agreement (“RCA”) dated June 1, 2004 between Helen of  Troy, L.P., as borrower, and Bank of America N.A. and other lenders.  The amendment extended the maturity date until December 15, 2013 and modified certain terms and covenants.  For additional information regarding the amendment, see Note (6) to the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The amendment to the RCA increased our borrowing costs and adjusted the limitations on our ability to incur additional debt.  In addition, in the event of new disruptions in the financial markets and an increased level of recent banking failures, current or future lenders may become unwilling or unable to continue to advance funds under any agreements in place, increase their commitments under existing credit arrangements or enter into new financing arrangements.  The failure of our lenders to provide

 

17



Table of Contents

 

sufficient financing may constrain our ability to operate or grow the business and to make complementary strategic business and/or brand acquisitions.  This could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our operating results may be adversely affected by foreign currency fluctuations.

 

Our functional currency is the U.S. Dollar. Changes in the relation of other foreign currencies to the U.S. Dollar will affect our sales and profitability and can result in exchange losses because the Company has operations and assets located outside the United States.  The Company transacts a significant portion of its business in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar (“foreign currencies”).  Such transactions include sales, certain inventory purchases and operating expenses. As a result, portions of our cash, trade accounts receivable and trade accounts payable are denominated in foreign currencies.  Accordingly, foreign operations will continue to expose us to foreign currency fluctuations, both for purposes of actual conversion and financial reporting purposes.  Additionally, we purchase a substantial amount of our products from Chinese manufacturers.  While the Chinese Renminbi remained relatively stable against the U.S. Dollar during fiscal 2010, it appreciated significantly against the U.S. Dollar in fiscal 2009 and 2008 and some news reports suggest future appreciation is likely during fiscal 2011.  Although our purchases are in U.S. Dollars, if the Chinese Renminbi were to resume its rise against the U.S. Dollar, the costs of our products would likely rise over time because of the impact the fluctuations will have on our suppliers, and we may not be able to pass any or all of these price increases on to our customers.

 

Where operating conditions permit, we seek to reduce foreign currency risk by purchasing most of our inventory with U.S. Dollars and by converting cash balances denominated in foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars.

 

We have historically hedged against certain foreign currency exchange rate-risk by using a series of forward contracts designated as cash flow hedges to protect against the foreign currency exchange risk inherent in our forecasted transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar.  In these transactions, we execute a forward currency contract that will settle at the end of a forecasted period.  Because the size and terms of the forward contract are designed so that its fair market value will move in the opposite direction and approximate magnitude of the underlying foreign currency’s forecasted exchange gain or loss during the forecasted period, a hedging relationship is created.  To the extent we forecast the expected foreign currency cash flows from the period the forward contract is entered into until the date it will settle with reasonable accuracy, we significantly lower or materially eliminate a particular currency’s exchange risk exposure over the life of the related forward contract. We enter into these types of agreements where we believe we have meaningful exposure to foreign currency exchange risk and the hedge pricing appears reasonable.  It is not practical for us to hedge all our exposures, nor are we able to project in any meaningful way the possible effect and interplay of all foreign currency fluctuations on translated amounts or future net income.  This is due to our constantly changing exposure to various currencies, the fact that each foreign currency reacts differently to the U.S. Dollar and the significant number of currencies involved.

 

The impact of future exchange rate fluctuations on our results of operations cannot be accurately predicted.  Accordingly, there can be no assurance that U.S. Dollar foreign exchange rates will be stable in the future or that fluctuations in foreign currency markets will not have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

18



Table of Contents

 

Acquisitions may be more costly or less profitable than anticipated or we may not be able to identify suitable new acquisition opportunities, which may constrain our prospects for future growth and profitability and adversely affect the price of our common stock.

 

We are constantly looking for opportunities to make complementary strategic business and/or brand acquisitions. These acquisitions, if not favorably received by consumers, shareholders, analysts, and others in the investment community, could have a material adverse effect on the price of our common stock.  In addition, any acquisition involves numerous risks, including:

 

·     difficulties in the assimilation of the operations, technologies, products and personnel associated with the acquisitions;

 

·     difficulties in integrating distribution channels;

 

·     diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns;

 

·     difficulties in transitioning and preserving customer, contractor, supplier and other important third party relationships;

 

·     difficulties realizing anticipated cost savings, synergies and other benefits related to an acquisition;

 

·     risks associated with subsequent operating asset write-offs, contingent liabilities, and impairment of related acquired intangible assets;

 

·     risks of entering markets in which we have no or limited experience; and

 

·     potential loss of key employees associated with the acquisitions.

 

Any difficulties encountered with acquisitions could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

 

We may incur debt to fund acquisitions and capital expenditures, which could have an adverse impact on our business and profitability.

 

Our debt could adversely affect our financial condition and can add constraints on our ability to operate our business.  Our indebtedness can, among other things:

 

·     increase our vulnerability to general adverse economic conditions;

 

·     limit our ability to obtain necessary financing and to fund future working capital, capital expenditures and other general corporate requirements;

 

·     require us to dedicate a portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our indebtedness, thereby reducing the availability of our cash flow to fund working capital and capital expenditures, and for other general corporate purposes;

 

·     subject us to a higher interest expense (a significant portion of our debt is fixed or effectively fixed through the use of interest rate swaps and these rates may produce higher interest expense than would be available with floating rate debt, as is currently the case with decreased market interest rates);

 

·     limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry in which we operate;

 

·     place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that have less debt;

 

19



Table of Contents

 

·     limit our ability to pursue acquisitions or sell assets; and

 

·     limit our ability to borrow additional funds.

 

Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on us. In addition, our debt agreements contain restrictive financial and operational covenants. Significant restrictive covenants include limitations on, among other things, our ability under certain circumstances to:

 

·     incur additional debt, including guarantees;

 

·     grant certain types of liens;

 

·     sell or otherwise dispose of assets;

 

·     engage in mergers, acquisitions or consolidations;

 

·     pay dividends on our common stock;

 

·     repurchase our common stock;

 

·     enter into substantial new lines of business; and

 

·     enter into certain types of transactions with our affiliates.

 

Our failure to comply with these and other restrictive covenants could result in an event of default, which if not cured or waived, could have a material adverse effect on us.

 

We rely on our central Global Enterprise Resource Planning Systems and other peripheral information systems.  Obsolescence or interruptions in the operation of our computerized systems or other information technologies could have a material adverse effect on our operations and profitability.

 

We conduct most of our businesses under one integrated Global Enterprise Resource Planning System (“ERP”), which we originally implemented in September 2004. Most of our operations are dependent on this system. We continuously make adjustments to improve the effectiveness of the ERP and other peripheral information systems. Any failures or disruptions in the ERP and other information systems or any complications resulting from adjustments could cause interruption or loss of data in our information or logistical systems that could materially impact our ability to procure products from our factories and suppliers, transport them to our distribution centers, and store and deliver them to our customers on time and in the correct amounts. In addition, natural disasters or other extraordinary events may disrupt our information systems and other infrastructure, and our data recovery processes may not be sufficient to protect against loss. Furthermore, application program bugs, system conflict crashes, user error, data integrity issues, customer data conflicts and integration issues all pose significant risks.

 

We rely on certain outside vendors to assist us with implementation of, and enhancements to, our information systems and other vendors to assist us in maintaining some of our infrastructure. Should any of these vendors fail to perform as expected, it could adversely affect our service levels and threaten our ability to conduct business. In addition, at the end of fiscal 2010, we have not completed the migration of our core software to newer versions because of the degree of customization it underwent upon its initial installation. This places our software vendor’s ability to continue to provide the appropriate level of support for these systems at risk.

 

These factors described above could cause significant disruptions to our business and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

20



Table of Contents

 

Audits and related disputes with taxing authorities could have an adverse impact on our business.

 

From time to time, we are involved in tax audits and related disputes with various taxing jurisdictions.  We believe that we have complied with all applicable reporting and tax payment obligations and in the past have disagreed with taxing authority positions on various issues.  Historically, we have vigorously defended our tax positions through available administrative and judicial avenues.  Based on currently available information, we have established reserves for our best estimate of the probable tax liabilities.  Future actions by taxing authorities may result in tax liabilities that are significantly higher or lower than the reserves established, which could have a material effect on our consolidated results of operations or cash flows.  For more information about tax audits and related disputes, see Note (9) to the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

 

Potential changes in laws, including tax laws, and the costs and complexities of compliance with such laws could have an adverse impact on our business.

 

The impact of future legislation in the U.S. or abroad, including such things as climate change related legislation, tax legislation, regulations or treaties, including any that would affect the companies or subsidiaries that comprise our consolidated group is always uncertain. The U.S. Congress continues to consider certain proposed changes in the tax laws, and new energy and environmental legislation that, if enacted, may increase our costs of doing business.  Our ability to respond to such changes, the cost and complexity of compliance with new law changes, and their impact on our ability to operate economically and effectively in jurisdictions always presents a risk.

 

Under current tax law,  favorable tax treatment of our non-U.S. net income is dependent on our ability to avoid classification as a Controlled Foreign Corporation. Changes in the composition of our stock ownership could have an impact on our classification. If our classification were to change, it could have a material adverse effect on the largest U.S. shareholders and, in turn, on the Company’s business.

 

A non-U.S. corporation, such as ours, will constitute a “controlled foreign corporation” or “CFC” for U.S. federal income tax purposes if its largest U.S. shareholders (i.e., those owning 10 percent or more of its shares) together own more than 50 percent of the stock outstanding.  If the IRS or a court determined that we were a CFC, then each of our U.S. shareholders who own (directly, indirectly, or constructively) 10 percent or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of our stock on the last day of our taxable year would be required to include in gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of our “subpart F income” (and the subpart F income of any our subsidiaries determined to be a CFC) for the period during which we (and our non-U.S. subsidiaries) were a CFC. In addition, any gain on the sale of our shares realized by such a shareholder may be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the shareholder’s proportionate share of our and our CFC subsidiaries’ undistributed earnings and profits accumulated during the shareholder’s holding period of the shares while we are a CFC.

 

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

 

Not Applicable.

 

21



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES

 

PLANT AND FACILITIES

 

The Company owns, leases, or otherwise utilizes through third-party management service agreements, a total of 31 facilities, which include selling, procurement, administrative and distribution facilities worldwide.  All facilities operated by the Company are adequate for the purpose for which they are intended.  Information regarding the location, use, segment, ownership and approximate size of the facilities and undeveloped land as of February 28, 2010 is provided below:

 

Location

 

Type and Use

 

Business Segment

 

Owned or
Leased

 

Approximate
Size (Square
Feet / Acres)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

El Paso, Texas, USA

 

Land & Building - Corporate Headquarters

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Owned

 

135,000

 

El Paso, Texas, USA

 

Land & Building - Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Owned

 

408,000

 

Southaven, Mississippi, USA

 

Land & Building - Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Owned

 

1,200,000

 

Brampton, Ontario, Canada

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

75,000

 

Danbury, Connecticut, USA

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

16,000

 

Bentonville, Arkansas, USA

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

5,000

 

Minneapolis, Minnesota, USA

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

1,000

 

New York, New York, USA

 

Office Space

 

Housewares

 

Leased

 

25,000

 

Chambersburg, Pennsylvania, USA

 

Office Space - Customer Service Facility

 

Housewares

 

Leased

 

3,200

 

El Paso, Texas, USA

 

Land - Held for Future Expansion

 

None

 

Owned

 

12 Acres

 

Southaven, Mississippi, USA

 

Land - Held for Future Expansion

 

None

 

Owned

 

31 Acres

 

Burlington, Ontario, Canada

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

5,000

 

Sheffield, England

 

Land & Building - European Headquarters

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Owned

 

10,000

 

Darwen, England

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Leased

 

75,000

 

Boulgne-Billancourt, France

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Leased

 

1,400

 

Nr Amsterdam, Netherlands

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

85,000

 

Mexico City, Mexico

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Owned

 

3,900

 

Mexico City, Mexico

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

75,200

 

Nuevo Leon, Mexico

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

9,700

 

Jalisco, Mexico

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

11,600

 

Cuautitlan Izcalli, Edo de Mexico

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

9,700

 

Vitoria, Brazil

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

2,400

 

Lima, Perú

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

900

 

Lima, Perú

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

1,500

 

Caracas, Venezuela

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

1,300

 

Aragua, Venezuela

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

3,300

 

Santiago, Chile

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

250

 

Santiago, Chile

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Personal Care

 

Leased

 

150

 

Tokyo, Japan

 

Office Space

 

Housewares

 

Leased

 

1,000

 

Hong Kong, China

 

Third-Party Managed Distribution Facility

 

Housewares

 

Leased

 

3,500

 

Zhu Kuan, Macau, China

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Leased

 

8,000

 

Shenzhen, China

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Leased

 

5,500

 

Shenzhen, China

 

Office Space

 

Personal Care & Housewares

 

Leased

 

14,500

 

 

22



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 3.  LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

 

We are involved in various legal claims and proceedings in the normal course of operations.  In the opinion of management, the outcome of these matters will not have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, results of operations or liquidity.

 

23



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 4.  RESERVED

 

24



Table of Contents

 

PART II

 

ITEM 5.  MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK

 

Our common stock is listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market (“NASDAQ”) [symbol: HELE].  The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, in dollars per share, the high and low sales prices of the common stock as reported on the NASDAQ.  These quotations reflect the inter-dealer prices, without retail mark-up, markdown, or commission and may not necessarily represent actual transactions.

 

 

 

High

 

Low

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 FISCAL 2010

 

 

 

 

 

First quarter

 

$

 20.09

 

$

 8.55

 

Second quarter

 

22.77

 

15.89

 

Third quarter

 

24.50

 

18.50

 

Fourth quarter

 

25.88

 

20.67

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 FISCAL 2009

 

 

 

 

 

First quarter

 

$

 18.49

 

$

 14.59

 

Second quarter

 

24.21

 

15.26

 

Third quarter

 

24.70

 

13.31

 

Fourth quarter

 

17.92

 

9.61

 

 

APPROXIMATE NUMBER OF EQUITY SECURITY HOLDERS OF RECORD

 

Our common stock with a par value of $0.10 per share is our only class of equity security outstanding at February 28, 2010.  As of May 10, 2010, there were approximately 260 holders of record of the Company’s common stock. Shares held in “nominee” or “street” name at each bank nominee or brokerage house are included in the number of shareholders of record as a single shareholder.

 

CASH DIVIDENDS

 

Our current policy is to retain earnings to provide funds for the operation and expansion of our business and for potential acquisitions.  We have not paid any cash dividends on our common stock since inception.  Our current intention is to pay no cash dividends in fiscal 2011.  Any change in dividend policy will depend upon future conditions, including earnings and financial condition, general business conditions, any applicable contractual limitations, and other factors deemed relevant by our Board of Directors.

 

25



Table of Contents

 

ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

Under the latest program approved by our Board of Directors, as of February 28, 2010 we are authorized to purchase up to 1,280,650 shares of common stock in the open market or through private transactions.   For the fiscal years ended 2010, 2009 and 2008, we repurchased and retired 47,648, 574,365 and 1,095,392 shares of common stock at a total purchase price of $0.42, $7.42 and $26.00 million, and an average purchase price of $8.80, $12.91 and $23.74 per share, respectively.  In addition, during the fiscal quarters ended May 31, 2009 and November 30, 2009, our chief executive officer tendered certain shares of common stock as payment for the exercise price and related federal tax obligations arising from the exercise of options.   We accounted for this activity as a purchase and retirement of the shares.   The table below summarizes these option exercise transactions:

 

SHARES TENDERED FOR THE EXERCISE OF OPTIONS FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 2010

 

Transaction Date

 

Total Number of
Shares Subject to
Options
Exercised

 

Total Number of
Shares Tendered
in Payment of the
Exercise Price
and Related
Federal Taxes

 

Fair Market
Value of shares at
the Transaction
Date
(in thousands)

 

Average Price
per Share
Tendered

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 May 14, 2009

 

1,000,000

 

762,519

 

$

14,600

 

$

19.15

 

 October 8, 2009

 

1,000,000

 

675,590

 

15,552

 

23.02

 

Totals / average

 

2,000,000

 

1,438,109

 

$

30,152

 

$

20.97

 

 

There was no repurchase activity for the last quarter of fiscal 2010.

 

26



Table of Contents

 

PERFORMANCE GRAPH

 

The graph below compares the cumulative total return of our Company to the NASDAQ Market Index and a peer group index, assuming $100 invested March 1, 2005. The Peer Group Index is the Dow Jones—U.S. Personal Products, Broad Market Cap, Yearly, and Total Return Index.  The comparisons in this table are required by the SEC and are not intended to forecast or be indicative of the possible future performance of our common stock.

 

COMPARISON OF FIVE-YEAR CUMULATIVE RETURN
FOR HELEN OF TROY LIMITED, PEER GROUP INDEX AND NASDAQ
MARKET INDEX

 

 

 

Fiscal year ended the last day of February

 

 

 

2005

 

2006

 

2007

 

2008

 

2009

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED

 

100.00

 

70.64

 

81.77

 

55.75

 

35.45

 

85.33

 

PEER GROUP INDEX

 

100.00

 

100.47

 

124.51

 

132.87

 

95.32

 

141.80

 

NASDAQ MARKET INDEX

 

100.00

 

111.19

 

117.76

 

110.71

 

67.16

 

109.09

 

 

The Performance Graph shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC or subject to the liabilities of Section 18 under the Exchange Act.  In addition, it shall not be deemed incorporated by reference by any statement that incorporates this annual report on Form 10-K by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933 or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that we specifically incorporate this information by reference.

 

27


 


Table of Contents

 

ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The selected consolidated statements of income data for the years ended on the last day of February 2010, 2009 and 2008, and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as of the last day of February 2010 and 2009, have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements included in this report.  The selected consolidated statements of  income data for the years ended on the last day of February 2007 and 2006, and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as of the last day of February 2008, 2007 and 2006, have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements which are not included in this report.  This information should be read together with the discussion in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements and notes to those statements included in this report.  All currency amounts are denominated in U.S. Dollars.

 

Years Ended The Last Day of February,

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

 

2010 (3)

 

2009

 

2008 (1)(2)

 

2007

 

2006

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Statements of Income Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

$

634,932

 

$

589,747

 

Cost of goods sold

 

368,470

 

367,343

 

370,853

 

355,552

 

323,189

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

279,156

 

255,402

 

281,695

 

279,380

 

266,558

 

Selling, general and administrative expense

 

188,887

 

188,344

 

207,771

 

208,964

 

195,180

 

Operating income before impairments and gain

 

90,269

 

67,058

 

73,924

 

70,416

 

71,378

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

900

 

107,274

 

4,983

 

-    

 

-    

 

Gain on sale of land

 

-    

 

-    

 

(3,609

)

-    

 

-    

 

Operating income (loss)

 

89,369

 

(40,216

)

72,550

 

70,416

 

71,378

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Nonoperating income (expense), net

 

1,046

 

2,438

 

3,748

 

2,643

 

1,290

 

Interest expense

 

(10,310

)

(13,687

)

(15,025

)

(17,912

)

(16,866

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

80,105

 

(51,465

)

61,273

 

55,147

 

55,802

 

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

8,288

 

5,328

 

(236

)

5,060

 

6,492

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

   71,817

 

$

   (56,793

)

$

61,509

 

$

50,087

 

$

49,310

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Per Share Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

2.38

 

$

(1.88

)

$

2.01

 

$

1.66

 

$

1.65

 

Diluted

 

$

2.32

 

$

(1.88

)

$

1.93

 

$

1.58

 

$

1.56

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares of common stock used in computing net earnings (loss) per share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

30,217

 

30,173

 

30,531

 

30,122

 

29,919

 

Diluted

 

30,921

 

30,173

 

31,798

 

31,717

 

31,605

 

 

28



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA, CONTINUED

 

Last Day of February,

(in thousands)

 

 

2010 (3)

 

2009

 

2008 (1) (2)

 

2007

 

2006

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance Sheet Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Working capital

 

$

254,060

 

$

233,218

 

$

276,304

 

$

238,131

 

$

185,568

 

Total assets

 

834,733

 

822,126

 

911,993

 

906,272

 

857,744

 

Long-term debt

 

131,000

 

134,000

 

212,000

 

240,000

 

254,974

 

Stockholders’ equity (4)

 

583,772

 

508,693

 

568,376

 

527,417

 

475,377

 

Cash dividends

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

 

(1)  Fiscal year 2008 and thereafter includes the results of operations of Belson Products, which we acquired on May 1, 2007 for a net cash purchase price of $36.50 million including the assumption of certain liabilities.  The acquisition was funded with cash.  In connection with the acquisition, we recorded $13.98 million of working capital, $0.14 million of fixed assets, and $22.38 million of goodwill, trademarks and other intangible assets.

 

(2)  During fiscal 2008, we settled certain tax disputes with the Hong Kong Inland Revenue Department, and the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”).  As a result of these settlements, we recorded tax benefits totaling $9.31 million during fiscal 2008.  These benefits represent the reversal of tax provisions previously established for the periods under dispute.  See Note (9) to our consolidated financial statements for more information on our income taxes.

 

(3)  Fiscal year 2010 includes the results of operations of Infusium, which we acquired on March 31, 2009 for a cash purchase price of $60.00 million.  The acquisition was funded with cash.  At acquisition, we recorded $19.70 million of goodwill, $18.70 million of trademarks, $21.00 million for a customer list and $0.6 million of patent rights.

 

(4)  For the fiscal years ended 2010, 2009 and 2008, we repurchased and retired 1,485,757, 574,365 and 1,095,392 shares of common stock at a total purchase price of $30.57, $7.42 and $26.00 million, respectively.  No shares of common stock were repurchased during the fiscal years ended 2007 and 2006.

 

29



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (“MD&A”) should be read in conjunction with the other sections of this report, including Part I, “Item 1.  Business”;  Part II, “Item 6. Selected Financial Data”; and Part II, “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” The various sections of this MD&A contain a number of forward-looking statements, all of which are based on our current expectations. Actual results may differ materially due to a number of factors, including those discussed on page 2 of this report in the section entitled  “Information Regarding Forward-Looking Statements,”  Item 1A., “Risk Factors,” and in Item 7A. “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.”

 

OVERVIEW

 

In fiscal 2010, Helen of Troy confronted extraordinary global macroeconomic conditions which contracted consumer discretionary spending in the U.S. and internationally.  In the face of declining comparable store sales, particularly earlier in the year, many of our retail partners reduced both the number of stock keeping units (SKU’s) they carried and the number of days of on-hand inventory carried.  Although retail inventory levels appear to have stabilized, the economy has continued to negatively impact retail sales, primarily with respect to our personal care appliance product sales.  When consumers did spend, the general trend was to trade down to lower price points, especially within our appliance product group.  Another factor contributing to our appliance business results was the negative impact of a strengthening U.S. dollar versus most other currencies in the first and second quarters of fiscal 2010.  Generally, a stronger U.S. dollar means that foreign results translated into fewer U.S. dollars on a reported basis.  Sales declines in the core Personal Care business were offset with new sales from our recently acquired Ogilvie® (“Ogilvie”) line of home permanent and straightening products and Infusium line of shampoos and conditioners and continued organic growth in our Housewares segment.  The Housewares segment has proven to be much more resistant to the impacts of the recent economic downturn.

 

Although the global economy has shown some signs of improvement recently, we believe that many of our consumers still face difficult circumstances, which may not significantly change during fiscal 2011.  We expect that net sales revenue performance in many of our Personal Care segment’s product lines will likely lag pre-recession averages and be heavily dependent on real improvements in employment, housing markets, and consumers’ personal finances.

 

We prepared for and responded to these difficult circumstances with an intense, disciplined focus on creating operational efficiencies and improving our ability to execute against ever more challenging customer requirements.  We continue to leverage the investments we made in our information technology and distribution infrastructure and have implemented a number of cost-containment programs.  We also benefited from the impact on our cost of goods sold of commodity price decreases we received early during the fiscal year.  As a result, in a difficult year, we generated the second highest net income in our Company’s history.  During the next fiscal year, we will continue to focus on our initiatives.  Current significant initiatives include the integration of the Pert Plus hair care and Sure anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses acquired from Innovative Brands, LLC, further efficiency initiatives, and our commitment to consumer relevant product innovation and service delivery.

 

Helen of Troy continues to maintain a solid financial foundation, with no short term debt outstanding at the end of fiscal 2010, relatively modest long-term debt leverage and cash and cash equivalents totaling more than $110 million. This solid financial position and continued strong cash flow generation have provided us with the flexibility to make ongoing investments in our core business, while seeking new sales growth opportunities through selective acquisitions.

 

30



Table of Contents

 

Significant Developments and Events during Fiscal 2010

 

·                  Acquisition of Infusium: On March 31, 2009, we completed the acquisition of certain assets, trademarks, customer lists, distribution rights, patents, goodwill and formulas for Infusium hair care products from The Procter & Gamble Company for a cash purchase price of $60 million, which we paid with cash on hand.  Infusium has a heritage of over 80 years and its shampoos, conditioners, and leave-in treatments have an established reputation for product performance with stylists and consumers. The acquisition was a significant addition to the Company’s Personal Care segment, yet required minimal additional staffing and infrastructure to integrate. We are marketing Infusium products in both retail and professional trade channels.  The fiscal year ended February 28, 2010 includes eleven months of Infusium net sales revenue totaling $34.19 million.  For further information regarding the acquisition, see Note (5) in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.

 

·                  Strategic Brand Licensing Agreements:  During the fiscal quarter ended May 31, 2009, we began earning royalties from strategic brand licensing agreements with Staples Inc. (“Staples”), the world’s largest office products company, and UCB S.A. (“UCB”), a global biopharmaceutical leader.  Staples now sells an exclusive assortment of more than 30 OXO branded office products.  UCB offers patients suffering from rheumatoid arthritis and related conditions an OXO branded syringe that is ergonomically designed to simplify self injection.   While the Staples and UCB royalty revenue streams are not yet significant, we believe they have attractive long term growth potential and will add value to OXO’s brand equity by extending its reach into new consumer categories.

 

·                  New Product Development and Innovation:  We are continually investing in new product development.  We believe this will position us to gain market share and take advantage of the economic upturn, when it occurs.  Although we must be selective and cost-conscious regarding our development efforts, we feel an overall contraction in product development efforts would be a shortsighted strategy.  In our Personal Care segment, we introduced 255 new products in fiscal 2010 and expect to launch another 234 products for fiscal 2011 under such brand names as Revlon®, Vidal Sassoon®, Bed Head®, Pro Beauty Tools™, Hot Tools, Dr. Scholl’s®, Scholl®, Mega Hot®, Brazilian Heat, Gold ‘N Hot® and Veet®.  In our Housewares segment, we launched 107 new products in fiscal 2010 and we plan to launch 155 new products in fiscal 2011.  For additional information on these new products, please see Item 1., “Business – Products.”

 

·                  Sourcing Initiatives:  Throughout fiscal 2010, we continued with our efforts to streamline our sourcing operations and secure product cost reductions through both better component pricing and value engineering.  These efforts, in combination with an improvement in sales mix and selective price increases, contributed to an improvement of 2.1 percentage points in our gross profit margin to 43.1 percent in fiscal 2010, compared to 41.0 percent in fiscal 2009.

 

Significant Subsequent Developments in Fiscal 2011

 

·                  Acquisition of Pert Plus and Sure Brands:   On March 31, 2010, we completed the acquisition of certain assets and liabilities of the Pert Plus hair care and Sure anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC for a net cash purchase price of $69 million (subject to certain potential post acquisition-adjustments), which we paid with cash on hand.  Net assets acquired consist principally of accounts receivable, finished goods inventories, prepaid expenses, goodwill, patents, trademarks, tradenames, product design specifications, production know-how, certain fixed assets, distribution rights and customer lists, less accounts payable and certain other current liabilities.  Pert Plus enjoys a long history as a leading brand in the $2 billion U.S. shampoo category.  Sure is one of the leading brands in the $1.7 billion U.S. anti-perspirant and deodorant category. We will market Pert Plus and Sure products primarily into U.S. retail trade channels.

 

31



Table of Contents

 

Financial Recap of Fiscal 2010

 

·                  Consolidated net sales revenue increased 4.0 percent, or $24.88 million, to $647.63 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $622.75 million in fiscal 2009.  Personal Care segment consolidated net sales revenue increased 0.4 percent in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009.  Housewares segment net sales revenue increased 13.1 percent in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009. Our fiscal 2010 net sales revenue includes the unfavorable impact of a net foreign exchange loss of $6.26 million compared to fiscal 2009.

 

·                  Consolidated gross profit margin as a percentage of net sales revenue increased 2.1 percentage points to 43.1 percent in fiscal 2010 compared to 41.0 percent in fiscal 2009.

 

·                  SG&A as a percentage of net sales revenue decreased 1.0 percentage point to 29.2 percent in fiscal 2010 compared to 30.2 percent in fiscal 2009.

 

·                  Interest expense was $10.31 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $13.69 million in fiscal 2009.  The decrease in interest expense was principally due to lower amounts of debt outstanding due to the scheduled retirement of $78.00 million of long-term debt during the year, when compared to fiscal 2009.

 

·                  Income tax expense was $8.29 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $5.33 million in fiscal 2009.  Fiscal 2009 income tax expense includes a benefit of $0.46 million due to a tax settlement with the IRS.

 

·                  Our net income of $71.82 million in fiscal 2010 compares to a net loss of $56.79 million in fiscal 2009.  In addition to an increase in current year net sales revenue and decreasing cost of goods sold, the year-over-year comparability of  our net income is affected by the impact of significant items in fiscal 2009, including: the effects of non-cash intangible impairment charges and a charge to bad debt associated with the Linens ‘n Things retail chain (“Linens”) bankruptcy, partially offset by the benefits of a tax settlement and gains on casualty insurance settlements.  Diluted earnings per share was $2.32 in fiscal 2010 compared to $1.59 in fiscal 2009, after excluding the significant items from fiscal 2009.  Income and related diluted earnings per share without significant items are non-GAAP financial measures as contemplated by SEC Regulation G, Rule 100.  These measures are discussed further and reconciled to their applicable GAAP-based measures on page 49.

 

Key Net Sales Revenue and Net Income Growth Drivers for Fiscal 2011

 

We plan to implement or continue the following specific initiatives for fiscal 2011 with the goal of achieving sales and net income growth:

 

·                  Continued growth and expansion of OXO product lines;

 

·                  Continued investment in new product line development and introductions to gain market share;

 

·                  Integration and development of our new Pert Plus and Sure product lines;

 

·                  Pursuit of additional acquisitions of complementary businesses or product lines;

 

·                  Continued sourcing and product cost management initiatives to offset expected commodity and inbound transportation cost increases; and

 

·                  Continued implementation of productivity initiatives to reduce operating expenses.

 

32



Table of Contents

 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, our selected operating data, in U.S. Dollars, as a percentage of net sales revenue, and as a year-over-year percentage change.

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended (in thousands)

 

% of Sales Revenue, net (1)

 

% Change

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

10/09

 

09/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care Segment

 

$449,151

 

$  447,244

 

$  488,414

 

69.4%

 

71.8%

 

74.8%

 

0.4%

 

-8.4%

 

Housewares Segment

 

198,475

 

175,501

 

164,134

 

30.6%

 

28.2%

 

25.2%

 

13.1%

 

6.9%

 

Total sales revenue, net

 

647,626

 

622,745

 

652,548

 

100.0%

 

100.0%

 

100.0%

 

4.0%

 

-4.6%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cost of goods sold

 

368,470

 

367,343

 

370,853

 

56.9%

 

59.0%

 

56.8%

 

0.3%

 

-0.9%

 

Gross profit

 

279,156

 

255,402

 

281,695

 

43.1%

 

41.0%

 

43.2%

 

9.3%

 

-9.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative expense

 

188,887

 

188,344

 

207,771

 

29.2%

 

30.2%

 

31.8%

 

0.3%

 

-9.4%

 

Operating income before impairments and gain

 

90,269

 

67,058

 

73,924

 

13.9%

 

10.8%

 

11.3%

 

34.6%

 

-9.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

900

 

107,274

 

4,983

 

0.1%

 

17.2%

 

0.8%

 

*  

 

*  

 

Gain on sale of land

 

-    

 

-    

 

(3,609

)

0.0%

 

0.0%

 

-0.6%

 

*  

 

*  

 

Operating income (loss)

 

89,369

 

(40,216

)

72,550

 

13.8%

 

-6.5%

 

11.1%

 

*  

 

*  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Nonoperating income (expense), net

 

1,046

 

2,438

 

3,748

 

0.2%

 

0.4%

 

0.6%

 

-57.1%

 

-35.0%

 

Interest expense

 

(10,310

)

(13,687

)

(15,025

)

-1.6%

 

-2.2%

 

-2.3%

 

-24.7%

 

-8.9%

 

Total other income (expense)

 

(9,264

)

(11,249

)

(11,277

)

-1.4%

 

-1.8%

 

-1.7%

 

-17.6%

 

-0.2%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

80,105

 

(51,465

)

61,273

 

12.4%

 

-8.3%

 

9.4%

 

*  

 

*  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

8,288

 

5,328

 

(236

)

1.3%

 

0.9%

 

0.0%

 

55.6%

 

*  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$  71,817

 

$   (56,793

)

$   61,509

 

11.1%

 

-9.1%

 

9.4%

 

*  

 

*  

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

*    Calculation is not meaningful

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)  Sales revenue percentages by segment are computed as a percentage of the related segment’s sales revenue, net to total sales revenue, net.  All other percentages are computed as a percentage of total sales revenue, net.

 

Consolidated Net Sales Revenue:

 

Consolidated net sales revenue increased $24.88 million or 4.0 percentage points in fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009.  New product acquisitions accounted for an increase of $39.00 million, or 6.3 percentage points, more than offsetting the decline in core business net sales revenue (net sales revenue without acquisitions).  Core business net sales revenue showed an overall decline in fiscal 2010 of $14.12 million or 2.3 percent.  Our Housewares segment provided 3.7 percentage points of consolidated net sales revenue growth, or an increase of $22.97 million.  Housewares’ net sales revenue increased 13.1 percent in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009, consisting of unit volume growth of 7.7 percent and an increase of 5.4 percent in average unit selling prices.  Our Personal Care segment provided 0.3 percentage points of consolidated net sales revenue growth, or an increase of $1.91 million. Personal Care’s net sales revenue increased 0.4 percent in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009, consisting of a 2.2 percent unit volume decline offset by a 2.6 percent average unit selling price increase.  Our fiscal 2010 net sales revenue include the unfavorable impact of a net foreign exchange loss of $6.26 million compared to fiscal 2009.

 

Consolidated net sales revenue decreased $29.80 million, or 4.6 percentage points, in fiscal 2009 compared to fiscal 2008.  New product acquisitions accounted for an increase of $6.84 million, or 1.0 percentage point, partially offsetting the decline in core business net sales revenue (net sales revenue without acquisitions).  Net sales revenue from new product acquisitions included $4.13 million of net sales revenue from our Belson Products acquisition, which represents two months of Belson’s fiscal 2009 net sales revenue through the first anniversary of their acquisition, and $2.71 of net sales revenue from our Ogilvie acquisition, which represents 4.3 months of net sales revenue of Ogilvie products since acquisition.  Core business net sales revenue showed an overall decline in fiscal 2009 of $36.64 million or 5.6 percent.  Our Housewares segment provided 1.7

 

33



Table of Contents

 

percentage points of consolidated net sales revenue growth, or an increase of $11.37 million.  Housewares’ net sales revenue increased 6.9 percent in fiscal 2009 when compared to fiscal 2008, consisting of unit volume growth of 14.1 percent, partially offset by a decline in average unit selling prices of 7.2 percent.  Housewares’ growth was more than offset by a decline in net sales revenue of 8.4 percent, or $41.17 million, in our Personal Care segment. The 8.4 percent decrease in our Personal Care segment consisted of a 10.0 percent unit volume decline and a 1.6 percent overall price increase.  Fiscal 2009 net sales revenue include a net unfavorable foreign exchange impact of $8.78 million compared to fiscal 2008.

 

The following table summarizes, for the periods indicated, the impact that acquisitions had on our net sales revenue:

 

IMPACT OF ACQUISITION ON SALES REVENUE, NET

(in thousands)

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Prior year’s sales revenue, net

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

$

634,932

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Components of sales revenue change, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Core business

 

(14,118

)

(36,640

)

(9,061

)

Acquisitions (non-core busines sales revenue, net)

 

38,999

 

6,837

 

26,677

 

Change in sales revenue, net

 

24,881

 

(29,803

)

17,616

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total sales revenue growth, net

 

4.0%

 

-4.6%

 

2.8%

 

Core business

 

-2.3%

 

-5.6%

 

-1.4%

 

Acquisitions

 

6.3%

 

1.0%

 

4.2%

 

 

Segment Net Sales Revenue:

 

SALES REVENUE, NET BY SEGMENT

(dollars in thousands)

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

$ Change

 

 

 

% Change

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

Volume

 

Price

 

Net

 

 

 

Volume

 

Price

 

Net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care

 

$

449,151

 

$

447,244

 

$

(9,736

)

$

11,643

 

$

1,907

 

 

 

-2.2%

 

2.6

%

0.4

%

Housewares

 

198,475

 

175,501

 

13,425

 

9,549

 

22,974

 

 

 

7.7%

 

5.4

%

13.1

%

Total sales revenue, net

 

$

647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

3,689

 

$

21,192

 

$

24,881

 

 

 

0.6%

 

3.4

%

4.0

%

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

$ Change

 

 

 

% Change

 

 

 

2009

 

2008

 

Volume

 

Price

 

Net

 

 

 

Volume

 

Price

 

Net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care

 

$

447,244

 

$

488,414

 

$

(49,067

)

$

7,897

 

$

(41,170

)

 

 

-10.0%

 

1.6

%

-8.4

%

Housewares

 

175,501

 

164,134

 

23,112

 

(11,745

)

11,367

 

 

 

14.1%

 

-7.2

%

6.9

%

Total sales revenue, net

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

$

(25,955

)

$

(3,848

)

$

(29,803

)

 

 

-4.0%

 

-0.6

%

-4.6

%

 

34



Table of Contents

 

Personal Care

 

Our Personal Care segment currently offers products in three categories: appliances; grooming, skin care and hair care solutions; and brushes, combs and accessories.

 

Fiscal 2010 Net Sales Revenue Compared to Fiscal 2009:

 

Net sales in our Personal Care segment increased 0.4 percent, or $1.91 million, to $449.15 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $447.24 million in fiscal 2009.  Net sales revenue from new product acquisitions included $4.81 million of net sales revenue from our Ogilvie products acquisition, which represents 7.7 months of Olgilvie’s fiscal 2010 net sales revenue through the first anniversary of their acquisition, and $34.19 million of net sales revenue from our Infusium acquisition, which represents 11 months of net sales revenue of Infusium products since acquisition.  Net sales revenue increases due to the Infusium and Ogilvie acquisitions were mostly offset due to the following factors:

 

·                  This segment of our business, in particular the appliance category,  experienced continued declines in consumer spending throughout the year as a result of the difficult economic environment.  When consumers did spend, the general trend was to trade down to lower price points.  At this point in our appliance product cycle, ionic and ceramic technical innovations, once considered key differentiators that justified higher prices, are widespread and are now available at all price points.

 

·                  While hair dryer purchasing is typically a “need” purchase where consumers react quickly to replace their existing dryer once it has ceased to operate properly, styling irons (straightening and curling) we believe are more discretionary items whose sales patterns are heavily influenced by fashion trends.  This past year, our largest declines occurred in the straightening iron category, while sales in the curling iron category remained relatively flat due to a resurgence of soft curls as a women’s fashion trend.

 

·                  Our fiscal 2010 net sales revenue includes the unfavorable impact of a net foreign exchange loss of $6.26 million, when compared to fiscal 2009, due to the continuing impact of a strengthening U.S. dollar versus most other currencies.  Other things being equal, a stronger dollar meant that foreign results translated into fewer dollars on a reported basis.  Most of this currency impact affected our appliance business sales.

 

·                  Contraction of our retail selling base, particularly smaller regional multi-store and individual accounts due to consolidation, bankruptcy and closures in a weak economy.

 

·                  The loss of some appliance placement due to branded and private label competition.

 

Fiscal 2009 Net Sales Revenue Compared to Fiscal 2008:

 

Net sales revenue in our Personal Care segment decreased 8.4 percent, or $41.17 million, to $447.24 million in fiscal 2009 compared to $488.41 million in fiscal 2008.  A general description of factors contributing to the change in net sales revenue for fiscal 2009 compared to fiscal 2008 follows:

 

·                  The continued deterioration of global macroeconomic conditions that began in fiscal 2008 and accelerated throughout fiscal 2009.  These conditions negatively affected consumer spending causing many of our retail partners to face declining same store sales trends and a highly promotional holiday season.  This environment had an adverse impact on both our foreign and domestic appliance businesses.

 

·                  In anticipation of a decline in consumer spending during the holiday season, key retail partners reduced inventory levels across most of our product categories, resulting in lower sales orders for most of fiscal 2009.  This trend reversed slightly in the fourth quarter as our retail partners replenished to support minimum inventory levels.

 

35



Table of Contents

 

·                  A significant strengthening of the U.S. Dollar against other currencies in which we transact sales, which exposed the Company to foreign exchange losses on those sales because our foreign currency sales prices are not adjusted for the currency fluctuations.

 

·                  Disruptions in product supply due to the closure of certain suppliers in the Far East.  This caused delays in the delivery of certain items and adversely affected Personal Care appliance net sales revenue.  Although we have multiple sourcing partners for many of our products, we were unable to source certain items on a timely basis due to the rapid changes occurring within the Far East.  We believe the contraction in suppliers was a widespread issue within our industry, which now appears to have stabilized.

 

·                  The loss of some appliance placement at retail due to branded competition, movement to private label and disruptions in the supply of product.

 

·                  An introduction of an entirely new line of hair care appliance solutions for specific hair types, VS Answers®, which replaced some of our existing product on our retailers’ shelves, fell short of our expectations due to disappointing sell-through and its launch at a time when retailers were cutting back shelf space and tightening their inventory management practices.

 

·                  In fiscal 2008, we introduced the Bed Head® line of appliances and accessories.  Due to a shift by consumers away from higher price points at retail, we granted certain price adjustments and allowances to our retailers as part of our commitment to Bed Head®, which negatively impacted fiscal 2009 Bed Head® net sales revenue.

 

·                  In Latin America, appliance volume decreased due to the combined effects of weakening local economies, particularly in Mexico, and the impact of sales disruptions in the Brazilian market caused by a fire at a third-party managed distribution facility.

 

·                  Prior to fiscal 2009, our Latin American region had historically experienced double-digit growth in the Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions category, but the combined effects of operating on a larger sales base, unfavorable foreign exchange rates and a downturn in Latin American economies stalled our growth in fiscal 2009.

 

·                  In North America, fiscal 2009 net sales revenue benefited from the acquisition of the Ogilvie brand home permanent and hair-straightening products on October 10, 2008, which contributed $2.71 million to the region’s net sales revenue.  Unit volume increases contributed 3.8 percent to net sales revenue growth, while average unit selling prices declined 4.5 percent.  Our North American region net sales revenue results reflect the difficult retail environment and the full year impact of the discontinuance of the Epil-Stop product line with certain key customers.

 

·                  In our Brushes, Combs, and Accessories product category, a combination of sluggish product sales in the mass retail channel, a general market decline in demand for fashion accessories, returns from key customers because of display changes at retail, and the loss of shelf space were significant contributing factors to the year-over-year decline.

 

36



Table of Contents

 

Housewares

 

Our Housewares segment reports the operations of OXO International whose products include kitchen tools, cutlery, bar and wine accessories, household cleaning tools, food storage containers, tea kettles, trash cans, storage and organization products, gardening tools, kitchen mitts and trivets, barbeque tools, and rechargeable lighting products.

 

Fiscal 2010 Net Sales Revenue Compared to Fiscal 2009:

 

Net sales revenue in our Housewares segment increased 13.1 percent, or $22.97 million, to $198.48 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $175.50 million in fiscal 2009.  Increased unit net sales volume contributed 7.7 percent to net sales revenue growth and higher average unit selling prices contributed 5.4 percent to net sales revenue growth.  We experienced growth both internationally and domestically with a disproportionate amount of the growth occurring domestically.  Key drivers of this growth are as follows:

 

·                  In the second half of fiscal 2010, we began significant shipments of our Good Grips® TOP line of modular wet food storage containers (“TOP Containers”) to complement our existing line of Good Grips® POP line of dry food storage containers (“POP Containers”), introduced late in fiscal 2008.  In fiscal 2010, the new line of TOP Containers accounted for $2.34 million of new product net sales revenue while our POP Container line continued to gain market share and accounted for incremental net sales revenue of $11.61 million over fiscal 2009.  Other new product introductions accounted for approximately $6.73 million in incremental net sales revenue.

 

·                  New distribution contributed $2.12 million in net sales revenue growth, while organic growth within existing accounts contributed the balance of the Housewares segment’s net sales revenue increase.

 

Future net sales revenue growth in this segment of our business will be dependent on new product innovation, continued product line expansion, new sources of distribution, and geographic expansion.  Domestically, our Housewares segment’s market opportunities are maturing and its current customer base amongst all tiers of retailers is extensive.  Accordingly, we remain cautious about our ability to maintain this same pace of net sales revenue growth in the foreseeable future.

 

Fiscal 2009 Net Sales Revenue Compared to Fiscal 2008:

 

Net sales revenue in our Housewares segment increased 6.9 percent, or $11.37 million, to $175.50 million in fiscal 2009 compared to $164.13 million in fiscal 2008.  Increased unit net sales volume contributed 14.1 percent to sales growth and lower average unit selling prices had a negative impact on net sales revenue of 7.2 percent.  Unit prices decreased due to sales of discontinued inventory and the de-emphasis of certain products with high unit prices but lower margins.  Unit volumes increased primarily due to new product introductions, improved distribution execution, growth with existing accounts, continued expansion of net sales revenue in the United Kingdom and Japan, and the sale of discontinued inventory.  Our POP line of modular food storage containers, which began shipping in late fiscal 2008, was a top selling category for us in fiscal 2009.   In fiscal 2009, food storage containers added $10.30 million of incremental net sales revenue growth.  In addition, in fiscal 2009, new product offerings such as digital instant read thermometers and a new line of dusting products in total accounted for approximately $7.89 million in incremental net sales revenue growth in the Housewares segment during a soft retail year.

 

37



Table of Contents

 

Geographic Net Sales Revenue:

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, our net sales revenue by geographic region, in U.S. Dollars, as a percentage of net sales revenue, and the year-over-year percentage change in each region.

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended (in thousands)

 

 

 

% of Sales Revenue, net (1)

 

 

 

% Change

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

10/09

 

09/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net by geographic region

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$511,027

 

$

476,147

 

$

505,817

 

 

 

78.9

%

76.5

%

77.5

%

 

 

7.3

%

-5.9

%

Canada

 

28,874

 

28,325

 

27,960

 

 

 

4.5

%

4.5

%

4.3

%

 

 

1.9

%

1.3

%

Europe and other

 

68,723

 

76,419

 

71,734

 

 

 

10.6

%

12.3

%

11.0

%

 

 

-10.1

%

6.5

%

Latin America

 

39,002

 

41,854

 

47,037

 

 

 

6.0

%

6.7

%

7.2

%

 

 

-6.8

%

-11.0

%

Total sales revenue, net

 

$647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

 

 

100.0

%

100.0

%

100.0

%

 

 

4.0

%

-4.6

%

 

(1)      Percentages of net sales revenue by geographic region are computed as a percentage of the geographic region’s net sales revenue to total net sales revenue.

 

In fiscal 2010, the U.S. contributed 5.6 percentage points to growth in our consolidated net sales revenue or $34.88 million, while international operations accounted for a 1.6 percentage point decline. Latin American operations accounted for a 0.5 percentage point decline in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $2.85 million.  Canadian operations accounted for a 0.1 percentage point increase in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $0.55 million.  Europe and other country operations accounted for a 1.2 percentage point decrease in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $7.70 million. Our Latin American and European operations, in particular their appliance categories, were negatively affected by the impact of their slow economies, which are recovering at a slower rate than the U.S.  Our international net sales revenue performance included the negative effects of foreign exchange losses on net sales revenue of $6.26 million in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009, principally due to the weakening of the British Pound and the Mexican Peso, respectively, against the U.S. Dollar.  In fiscal 2010, Canada, Europe and other, and Latin American regions accounted for approximately 21, 50 and 29 percent of international net sales revenue, respectively.

 

In fiscal 2009, the U.S. accounted for a 4.5 percentage point decline in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $29.67 million, while international operations were essentially flat overall. Latin American operations accounted for a 0.8 percentage point decline in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $5.18 million.  Canadian operations accounted for a 0.1 percentage point increase in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $0.37 million.  Europe and other country operations accounted for a 0.7 percentage point increase in our consolidated net sales revenue, or $4.69 million. Europe and other country growth continued to be driven by growth in our OXO Housewares and increases in sales of Toni & Guy® appliances.  Our international net sales revenue performance offset a negative foreign exchange impact of $8.78 million in fiscal 2009, $5.37 million of which was attributable to the weakening of the British Pound against the U.S. Dollar.  In fiscal 2009, Canada, Europe and other, and Latin American regions accounted for approximately 19, 52 and 29 percent of international net sales revenue, respectively.

 

Gross Profit Margins:

 

Gross profit, as a percentage of net sales revenue, increased to 43.1 percent in fiscal 2010 from 41.0 percent in fiscal 2009.  The primary components of the improvement are as follows:

 

·                  commodity price decreases early in fiscal 2010 that began to cycle through cost of goods sold in the second half of the fiscal year;

 

·                  a decrease in inbound freight costs;

 

·                  lower sourcing overhead as a result of the streamlining of our Far East sourcing operations;

 

·                  customer price increases and product mix improvements in the Housewares segment; and

 

38


 

 


Table of Contents

 

·                  the impact of the Infusium and Ogilvie acquisitions, which have comparatively higher margins than the core business.

 

China has suggested that it may move its currency off a peg to the U.S. dollar, which could result in an appreciation move and increase our product costs over time.  In addition, there has been upward pressure on raw material, labor and inbound transportation costs.  Accordingly, we remain cautious about the expectation of sustained gross profit margin improvement in fiscal 2011.  For additional information, see Item 1A. Risk Factors, under the sub-heading: “We are dependent on third party manufactures, most of which are located in the Far East, and any inability to obtain products from such manufacturers could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.”

 

Gross profit, as a percentage of net sales revenue, decreased to 41.0 percent in fiscal 2009 from 43.2 percent in fiscal 2008.  The primary components of the decline were as follows:

 

·                  Over the last half of fiscal year 2009, our reported consolidated net sales revenue was diluted by the strengthening of the U.S. Dollar against many foreign currencies while our cost of goods sold were not significantly impacted because we purchase the majority of our inventory in U.S. Dollars.  A reduction in net sales revenue without an offsetting reduction in cost of goods sold had a negative impact on our gross profit margins.

 

·                  The impact of increased product costs sourced from the Far East, which were driven by the appreciation of the Chinese Renminbi with respect to the U.S. Dollar and higher raw material, labor and inbound transportation costs.

 

Selling, general and administrative expense (“SG&A”):

 

In order to provide a better understanding of the impact that certain specified items had on our operations, the analysis that follows reports SG&A excluding the items described in the table below.  This financial measure is non-GAAP financial information as contemplated by SEC Regulation G, Rule 100, and the accompanying table reconciles this measure to the corresponding GAAP-based measure presented in our consolidated statements of income.

 

IMPACT OF SPECIFIED ITEMS ON SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSE

(dollars in thousands)

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

% of Sales Revenue, net

 

% Change

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

2010 

 

2009 

 

2008 

 

 

 

10/09

 

09/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SG&A, as reported

 

$188,887

 

$

188,344

 

$

207,771

 

 

 

29.2

%

30.2

%

31.8

%

 

 

0.3

%

-9.4

%

Bad debt expense

 

(493

)

(5,710

)

(484

)

 

 

-0.1

%

-0.9

%

-0.1

%

 

 

-91.4

%

 

*

Foreign exchange (losses) gains

 

1,735

 

(5,207

)

528

 

 

 

0.3

%

-0.8

%

0.1

%

 

 

 

*

 

*

Insurance claim gains

 

527

 

2,780

 

-    

 

 

 

0.1

%

0.4

%

0.0

%

 

 

-81.0

%

 

*

SG&A, without specified items

 

$190,656

 

$

180,207

 

$

207,815

 

 

 

29.4

%

28.9

%

31.8

%

 

 

5.8

%

-13.3

%

 

* Calculation is not meaningful

 

The Company believes that this non-GAAP measure provides useful information to management and investors regarding financial and business trends relating to its financial condition and results of operations.  The Company believes that this non-GAAP measure, in combination with the Company’s financial results calculated in accordance with GAAP, provides investors with additional perspective regarding the impact of specified items on SG&A.  The Company further believes that the specified items excluded from SG&A do not accurately reflect the underlying performance of its continuing operations for the period in which they are incurred, even though some of these excluded items may be incurred and reflected in the Company’s GAAP financial results in the foreseeable future.  The material limitation associated with the use of non-GAAP financial measures is that non-GAAP measures do not reflect the full economic impact of the Company’s activities.  The Company’s non-GAAP measure is not prepared in accordance with GAAP, is not an alternative to GAAP financial information, and may be calculated differently than non-GAAP financial information disclosed by other companies.  Accordingly, undue reliance should not be placed on non-GAAP information.

 

39



Table of Contents

 

SG&A decreased to 29.2 percent of net sales revenue in fiscal 2010 from 30.2 percent in fiscal 2009.  As shown in the above table, fiscal 2010 SG&A includes net foreign exchange gains of $1.74 million, bad debt expense of $0.49 million and insurance claim gains of $0.53 million, which results in a net favorable impact to SG&A of $1.77 million.  As shown in the above table, fiscal 2009 SG&A includes net foreign exchange losses of $5.21 million, bad debt expense of $5.71 million and insurance claim gains of $2.78 million, which results in a net unfavorable impact to SG&A of $8.14 million.  Excluding the impact of these items from both years, SG&A as a percentage of net sales revenue increased 0.5 percentage points to 29.4 percent in fiscal 2010 compared to 28.9 percent in fiscal 2009.  The underlying changes from 2009 were principally due to an increase in incentive compensation expense due to year-over-year improvement in overall financial results and higher intangible asset amortization as a result of recent acquisitions.

 

We continue to strive to improve our operations and processes, which we believe will ultimately help drive down costs.  We believe our competitive position and the long term health of our business depends on fulfillment and transportation excellence.  Our operations with our retailers, especially large retailers, have become increasingly intertwined. The breadth and complexity of the packaging, handling and shipping services we must render continue to escalate in order for us keep our current customers and to pursue opportunities to increase market share.  Consequently, it has become increasingly more expensive to do business with many of our customers and we expect this trend to continue.  Our Mississippi distribution center operations shipped approximately 72 percent of our consolidated gross sales volume during fiscal 2010 and have grown to a level where we may experience capacity constraints during peak shipping periods, should we continue to grow our sales revenue either through organic growth or acquisitions. These and other factors described above could cause delays in the delivery of our products and increases in shipping and storage costs.  Accordingly, we are cautious about the expectation of SG&A cost improvements in fiscal 2011.

 

SG&A decreased to 30.2 percent of net sales revenue in fiscal 2009 from 31.8 percent in fiscal 2008.  As shown in the above table, fiscal 2009 SG&A includes net foreign exchange losses of $5.21 million, bad debt expense of $5.71 million and insurance claim gains of $2.78 million, which results in a net unfavorable impact to SG&A of $8.14 million.  Fiscal 2008 SG&A includes net foreign exchange gains of $0.53 million and bad debt expense of $0.48 million, which results in a net favorable impact to SG&A of $0.04 million.  Excluding the impact of these items from both years, SG&A as a percentage of net sales revenue decreased 2.9 percentage points to 28.9 percent in fiscal 2009 compared to 31.8 percent in fiscal 2008.  The underlying improvements in 2009 were primarily the result of:

 

·                  A decrease in advertising expenses, primarily in our grooming, skin care and hair care solutions category due to a strategic decision to better focus media advertising and promotional expenditures.

 

·                  A decrease in variable selling expenses including royalties, sales commissions and outbound freight.

 

·                  Personnel expense other than distribution decreased primarily due to lower incentive compensation costs and insurance benefit costs.  Incentive compensation costs were $7.06 million lower in fiscal 2009, when compared to fiscal 2008 as a result of the impact of the Company’s net loss, including the impairments discussed below, on certain management incentive plans.

 

·                  Other impacts of a comprehensive cost reduction program which impacted a variety of other general and administrative expenses.

 

40



Table of Contents

 

Operating income by segment before impairments and gain

 

Operating income by segment before impairments and gain for fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008 was as follows:

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended (in thousands)

 

% of Sales Revenue, net (1)

 

% Change

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

10/09

 

09/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care

 

$

46,515

 

$

41,432

 

$

42,523

 

10.4

%

9.3

%

8.7

%

 

12.3

%

-2.6

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Housewares

 

43,754

 

25,626

 

31,401

 

22.0

%

14.6

%

19.1

%

 

70.7

%

-18.4

%

Total operating income before impairments and gain

 

$

90,269

 

$

67,058

 

$

73,924

 

13.9

%

10.8

%

11.3

%

 

34.6

%

-9.3

%

 

(1) Percentages by segment are computed as a percentage of the segments’ net sales revenue

 

Operating income before impairments and gain for each operating segment is computed based on net sales revenue, less cost of goods sold and any SG&A associated with the segment. The SG&A used to compute each segment’s operating profit are comprised of SG&A directly associated with the segment, plus overhead expenses that are allocable to the operating segment.

 

Personal Care

 

The Personal Care segment’s operating income before impairments and gain increased $5.08 million, or 12.3 percent, for fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009, and decreased $1.09 million, or 2.6 percent, for fiscal 2009 compared to fiscal 2008.

 

The increase in operating income before impairments and gain in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009, was primarily due to a slight increase in net sales revenue and an overall decrease in cost of goods sold, partially offset by increased SG&A costs.

 

The decrease in operating income before impairments and gain in fiscal 2009 when compared to fiscal 2008, was primarily due to net sales revenue declines, an overall increase in cost of goods sold and foreign exchange losses, which were partially offset by SG&A cost reductions and a one-time insurance claim gain.

 

Housewares

 

The Housewares segment’s operating income before impairment and gain increased $18.13 million, or 70.7 percent, for fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009.  The operating income increase in fiscal 2010 when compared to fiscal 2009 was primarily due to the combined effects of higher net sales revenue due to increased unit volume and unit selling price increases, certain unit cost of goods sold reductions and lower bad debt expense due to the impact of the Linens bankruptcy in fiscal 2009.

 

The Housewares segment’s operating income before impairments and gain decreased $5.78 million, or 18.4 percent, for fiscal 2009 compared to fiscal 2008.  The operating income decrease in fiscal 2009 when compared to fiscal 2008 resulted from higher cost of goods sold and the bad debt expense arising from the Linens bankruptcy, partially offset by the impact of net sales revenue increases.

 

41



Table of Contents

 

Impairment charges

 

The Company conducts its annual test of impairment of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets in the first quarter of each fiscal year. The Company also tests for impairment if events or circumstances indicate that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit or an indefinite-lived intangible asset is below its carrying amount.

 

Impairments in the Second Quarter of Fiscal 2010 - During the fiscal quarter ended August 31, 2009, a significant customer decided to discontinue carrying our Skin Milk® brand of skin care products.   Sales to this customer accounted for a substantial portion of the total sales of this brand, and accordingly, non-cash impairment charges were recorded to write off the remaining $0.90 million ($0.89 million after tax) in carrying value of the associated trademark.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2010 - The Company performed its annual evaluation of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment during the first quarter of fiscal 2010.  The Company believes that macroeconomic factors, specifically the decline in consumer demand and consumer confidence, did not deteriorate meaningfully during the first quarter of fiscal 2010, when compared to the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  Macroeconomic factors and market conditions, namely the sustained decline of the Company’s total market capitalization below the Company’s consolidated equity late in the third quarter of fiscal 2009 through the first half of the first quarter of fiscal 2010, were originally contributing factors to our determination that interim testing was necessary in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 and the associated impairments such testing produced.  However, the Company’s projected sales and operating income for its reporting units available at the end of the first quarter of fiscal 2010 did not vary significantly relative to previous estimates determined in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 and certain values used in our impairment testing methodology are based on market prices which had improved over the quarter.   Also, the Company’s common stock price recovered from the declines it experienced at the end of fiscal 2009.  These reasons, when considered together, caused us to conclude that further impairments had not occurred and extensive testing was not required for the quarter ended May 31, 2009.

 

Additional Impairment Testing in the Fourth Quarter of Fiscal 2009 – As a result of the continued deterioration of economic conditions during the second half of fiscal 2009, the Company evaluated the impact of these conditions and other developments on its reporting units to assess whether impairment indicators were present that would require interim impairment testing. During the latter half of the third quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company’s total market capitalization began to decline below the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity balance at November 30, 2008.  When the Company’s total market capitalization remains below its consolidated stockholders’ equity balance for a sustained period of time, this may be an indicator of potential impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets.  Because this condition continued throughout the balance of the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company determined that the carrying amount of our goodwill and other intangible assets might not be recoverable and performed additional impairment testing as of February 28, 2009.

 

In the tables and discussion that follow, we use the terms “market participant discount rate”, “terminal period”, and “terminal year revenue growth rates”.  The market participant discount rate is the weighted average cost of capital derived from a composite of similar companies that are in similar lines of business and serving similar distribution channels.  Inputs in the computation of the weighted average cost of capital are a risk free rate of return (we used long-term U.S. Treasury rates), a market risk premium (which represents the return on equity required by investors in similar types of businesses), an unsystematic risk premium (which accounts for the hypothetical risk facing investors in the reporting unit), the after tax cost of debt, and the average weights of debt and equity for similar companies.  The terminal period is the annual forecast used after the explicit forecast period that reflects a stable level of operations and is assumed to continue in perpetuity at the terminal year revenue growth rate and is used to determine the continuing value of the cash flows into perpetuity.  The terminal year revenue growth rate represents the revenue growth rate expected to continue in perpetuity.

 

42



Table of Contents

 

The Company’s traditional impairment test methodology previously used primarily estimated future discounted cash flow models (“DCF Models”).  Beginning in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company expanded its traditional impairment test methodology to give weight to other methods that provide additional observable market information, which management believes reflect the current risk level being incorporated into market prices, in order to corroborate the fair values of each of the Company’s reporting units.  These other methods include the Subject Company Stock Price Method, the Guideline Public Company Method, and the Mergers and Acquisitions Method (together, the “Market Models”). The Subject Company Stock Price Method uses the same revenue and earnings valuation multiples embedded in the Company’s common stock price, including an appropriate control premium, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.   The Guideline Public Company Method uses a composite of revenue and earnings multiples derived as of the valuation date from a group of publicly traded companies that are in similar lines of business and serving similar distribution channels as a basis for estimating the separate values, including appropriate control premiums for each of the Company’s reporting units.  The Mergers and Acquisitions Method uses the revenue and earnings multiples embedded in a group of representative business acquisition transactions, to the extent that comparable transactions are available, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.   For each of the methods used, considerable management judgment is necessary in reaching a conclusion regarding the reasonableness of fair value estimates, evaluating the most likely impact of a range of possible external conditions, considering the resulting operating changes and their impact on estimated future cash flows,  determining the appropriate discount factors to use, and selecting and weighting appropriate comparable market level inputs.

 

After determining the fair value of our reporting units using the DCF Models and the Market Models, the Company assigned weights to the valuation methods used based on management’s assessment of the extent to which the current economic environment affects each reporting unit’s value.  Management believes that each method used has relative merits and that by using multiple methods, particularly in times of economic uncertainty, a better estimate of fair value is determined.  Current accounting literature defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.  In applying weights to the various methods, the Company believes that its DCF Models capture management’s estimate regarding the results of its future prospects and its internal valuation for each reporting unit.  However, we also believe there was a divergence at that time between management’s expectations for its reporting units’ prospects and the market’s expectations based on observable market information.  Accordingly, management believes that the Market Models could more accurately reflect the value that a buyer would assign to the reporting units in the current economic environment.  Because fair value needs to consider the value of a company from both the buy side and the sell side of a potential transaction, the weights we assigned to the DCF Models and the Market Models attempted to balance this divergence in points of view.   We believe that the market has embedded significant discounts for risk into its valuations, and that the weightings we have assigned attempt to recognize the appropriate risk premiums the market would assign to each reporting unit.  In the future, the weightings assigned to the valuation methods may change as a result of changes in our business or market conditions.

 

The impairment testing for the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 was performed using an updated outlook for the Company’s reporting units completed in connection with its annual planning process.  This outlook included downward adjustments to certain future expected revenues and increases in the market participant discount rates, when compared to the projections and discount rates upon which our annual impairment tests were prepared during the first fiscal quarter of 2009.  The Company decreased its expected revenues in response to the reduction in consumer spending during the second half of fiscal 2009 and its expectation that depressed spending levels would persist into fiscal 2010.  Our projections assumed a continued but decelerating economic contraction through the first half of fiscal 2011, an economic recovery beginning in the second half of fiscal 2011 and general economic growth returning to slightly above mean levels in fiscal years 2012 through 2014.  Additionally, the Company increased the market participant discount rates used in its analysis because management believes that the lending market and the restrained liquidity in the fiscal 2009 environment increased the cost of capital.  In determining the extent to which to change its assumptions, management considered consumer spending trends and the anticipated impact on each reporting unit as well as the market cost of capital for comparable companies for each reporting unit.  The rates used in our projections are management’s estimate of the most likely results over time, given a wide range of potential outcomes. The assumptions and estimates used in our impairment testing involve significant elements of subjective judgment and analysis by the Company’s management. While we believe that these assumptions were reasonable when made, unanticipated events and circumstances may occur and cause actual results to differ materially from projected results based on these assumptions and estimates.

 

43



Table of Contents

 

During its evaluation of goodwill in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company determined that the carrying values of  the Personal Care segment’s Appliances and Accessories and Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions reporting units exceeded their fair values; consequently, further steps needed to be taken to determine the amounts by which goodwill and other intangible assets that were impaired.  The Company then reviewed the fair values of the individual reporting unit’s indefinite-lived intangibles for potential impairment.  The review used the lower of:  (1) the carrying value; or (2) the fair value using DCF Models under the relief from royalty method for trademarks, or using DCF Models under the excess earnings method for indefinite-lived licenses.  The discount rate utilized to value our indefinite-lived assets was one percent higher than the associated reporting unit’s market participant discount rate in order to reflect the higher rate of return that would likely be required when the associated trademark or license is sold as a separate asset.  In our case, after first recognizing additional impairments of indefinite-lived intangibles, we determined that 100 percent of recorded goodwill in our appliances and accessories reporting unit was impaired.

 

In total, we recorded non-cash impairment charges of $99.51 million ($99.06 million after tax) in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  This consisted of non-cash, pre-tax impairment charges of $46.49 million against goodwill and $2.75 million against a trademark in our Personal Care segment’s Appliances and Accessories reporting unit and $50.27 million against certain trademarks and an indefinite-lived license held by our Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions reporting unit.  The impairment for these reporting units was due to a decrease in the fair value of forecasted cash flows, and other market conditions reflecting the continued deterioration of the domestic and global economies and the declines in retail sales activity.

 

After we recorded the impairments discussed above, and reviewed all other long-lived assets of each reporting unit for potential impairment, the carrying values in our Personal Care segment reporting units as of February 28, 2009 still exceeded their estimated fair values as of that date.  Management believes these differences were within an acceptable range because:

 

·                  Estimates of fair value are inherently imprecise and typically fall within a reasonable range of all potential estimates;

 

·                  Conditions within the financial markets surrounding the evaluation date were extremely volatile and fair values in relatively short periods of time before and after the evaluation date produced estimates of fair market value for the Company as a whole which were significantly higher than the fair market value we reconciled to for the purposes of our review (See table below entitled: “Range of Estimates of Fair Value of Helen of Troy”); and

 

·                  For the Personal Care segment’s reporting units, all goodwill has been written off and all indefinite-lived intangibles have been reduced to their latest individual fair value estimates.

 

For fiscal 2009, no impairment charges were required for our Housewares segment as this reporting unit’s estimated fair value of total net assets including recorded goodwill, trademarks and other intangible assets, exceeded their carrying values as of the date of the evaluation.  We acquired the Housewares reporting unit on June 1, 2004.  Since that time it has experienced annual growth rates ranging from 6.9 to 26.0 percent with an average annual compound revenue growth rate of 15 percent over the last five years.  This reporting unit generated operating income as a percentage of net sales revenue ranging from 14.6 to 27.9 percent from fiscal 2005 to fiscal 2009, which was significantly higher than comparable percentages in our other reporting units over the same periods.  While considering the relative strength of Housewares reporting unit’s revenue and earnings metrics, we assumed a normal range of new product introductions and line extensions in the reporting unit based on historical levels, and that benefits from operating leverage will continue to allow for compound earnings growth rates that are appreciably higher than compound revenue growth rates.   Although the Housewares reporting unit did not incur impairments based on our fourth quarter fiscal 2009 analysis, it may be subject to future goodwill impairments.  The annual average compound earnings growth rate needed to avoid having a goodwill impairment charge is approximately 11 percent.  Based on the circumstance that existed at that time, if the annual average compound earnings growth rate were to fall below 11 percent over a five year forecast period, the Housewares reporting unit would incur a goodwill impairment charge, and depending on the severity of the drop, could incur impairment charges to its indefinite-lived trademark.   Additionally, assuming all other factors were to remain constant, if the market participant discount rate were to increase by 1 percent, the Housewares reporting unit would incur a goodwill impairment charge.  For both the goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets in the Housewares segment, the recoverability of these amounts is dependent upon achievement of the Company’s projections and the continued

 

44



Table of Contents

 

execution of key initiatives related to revenue growth and improved profitability. However, changes in business conditions and assumptions could potentially require future adjustments to these asset valuations.  The Company continues to monitor its reporting units for any triggering events or other signs of impairment.  The Company believes that its long-term growth strategy for the Housewares segment supports its fair value conclusions.

 

The table below summarizes the results of the impairment test in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009:

 

CARRYING VALUES AND ESTIMATED FAIR VALUES OF REPORTING UNITS

(in thousands)

 

As of the Fiscal Year Ended February 28, 2009 (1)

 

Personal Care Segment

 

 

Housewares Segment

 

 

 

 

 

 

Appliances
and
Accessories

 

% of
Total
Assets

 

Grooming,
Skin Care and
Hair Care
Solutions

 

% of
Total
Assets

 

 

 

Segment
Total (2)

 

% of
Total
Assets

 

 

Consolidated
Total

 

% of
Total
Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Intangible assets before fourth quarter impairments:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

$

46,490

 

13.6%

 

$

-

 

0.0%

 

 

 

$

166,131

 

38.7%

 

 

$

212,621

 

23.1%

Other indefinite-lived intangible assets

 

8,850

 

2.6%

 

90,634

 

60.5%

 

 

 

75,554

 

17.6%

 

 

175,038

 

19.0%

Other definite-lived intangible assets

 

7,081

 

2.1%

 

1,854

 

1.2%

 

 

 

12,702

 

3.0%

 

 

21,637

 

2.3%

Total intangible assets of each reporting unit

 

$

62,421

 

18.3%

 

$

92,488

 

61.7%

 

 

 

$

254,387

 

59.2%

 

 

$

409,296

 

44.4%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets before fourth quarter impairment

 

$

341,250

 

100.0%

 

$

149,854

 

100.0%

 

 

 

$

429,717

 

100.0%

 

 

$

920,821

 

100.0%

Total liabilities other than debt

 

(60,684)

 

-17.8%

 

(9,484)

 

-6.3%

 

 

 

(30,446)

 

-7.1%

 

 

(100,614)

 

-10.9%

Carrying value of each reporting unit before impairment

 

280,566

 

82.2%

 

140,370

 

93.7%

 

 

 

399,271

 

92.9%

 

 

820,207

 

89.1%

Less: Indefinite-lived intangible asset impairments

 

(2,750)

 

-0.8%

 

(50,274)

 

-33.5%

 

 

 

-     

 

-     

 

 

(53,024)

 

-5.8%

Goodwill impairments

 

(46,490)

 

-13.6%

 

-     

 

-     

 

 

 

-     

 

-     

 

 

(46,490)

 

-5.0%

Carrying value of each reporting unit after impairment

 

$

231,326

 

67.8%

 

$

90,096

 

60.1%

 

 

 

$

399,271

 

92.9%

 

 

$

720,693

 

78.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Estimated fair value as of February 28, 2009

 

$

226,000

 

 

 

$

71,000

 

 

 

 

 

$

407,000

 

 

 

 

$

704,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reported carrying value after impairment as a percent of estimated fair value

 

102.4%

 

 

 

126.9%

 

 

 

 

 

98.1%

 

 

 

 

102.4%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Significant assumptions used to determine fair values (by reporting unit):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Terminal year growth rates

 

2.5%

 

 

 

2.5%

 

 

 

 

 

3.5%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Market participant discount rates (cost of capital)

 

12.9%

 

 

 

13.1%

 

 

 

 

 

13.5%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Royalty rates used to compute the value of trademarks

 

2.5%

 

 

 

4.0% - 6.5%

 

 

 

 

 

5.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Control premiums used

 

20.6%

 

 

 

26.5%

 

 

 

 

 

37.1%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighting of discounted cash flow models

 

10.0%

 

 

 

10.0%

 

 

 

 

 

50.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighting of market comparables and market transactions

 

90.0%

 

 

 

90.0%

 

 

 

 

 

50.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sensitivity of estimated fair values:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair values in the event of a 1 percent increase in market participant discount rates

 

$

222,000

 

 

 

$

70,000

 

 

 

 

 

$

386,000

 

 

 

 

$

678,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair values in the event future revenues in each year only achieve 95 percent of their projected totals

 

$

221,000

 

 

 

$

70,000

 

 

 

 

 

$

388,000

 

 

 

 

$

679,000

 

 

 

(1) Percentages of total assets shown are before impairment.

(2) The total assets of the Housewares Segment includes $75 million of cash set aside to retire debt scheduled to mature on June 29, 2009.

 

For the purposes of our impairment testing in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the control premium we used for each reporting unit was determined from widely used published studies using the median premium over market capitalization that market participants paid for controlling interest targets within a comparable standard industrial classification group. Management believed the Housewares reporting unit had a higher control premium because of the fundamentals of the unit combined with relatively more attractive fundamentals for its industry as a whole when compared to the relative fundamentals of our other reporting units. We believed that the Housewares reporting unit also had a relatively higher potential for domestic and international growth through existing product categories and expansion into allied categories than our other reporting units.  Furthermore, this reporting unit had generated operating income as a percentage of net sales revenue ranging from 14.6 to 27.9 percent from fiscal 2005 to fiscal 2009, which is significantly higher than comparable percentages in our other reporting units and would support a higher control premium over that period.

 

45


 

 


Table of Contents

 

For the purposes of our impairment testing in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, for our Personal Care segment’s reporting units, we assigned a weight of 10 percent to our DCF Models and a weight of 90 percent to our Market Models. We utilized a lower weight on the DCF Models with respect to our Personal Care segment’s reporting units because of declines in revenue and relatively flat operating income percentages in these units from fiscal 2007 to fiscal 2009.  Additionally, considering the economic environment, we believed it was likely that market participants would discount any forecasts that show revenue growth over the intermediate term, even though we believed these forecasts to be reasonable at the time made. Conversely, for our Housewares reporting unit, we assigned a weight of 50 percent to both our DCF Models and our Market Models because our Housewares reporting unit showed positive revenue growth and comparatively higher operating income percentages over the same term, which we believed made its forecast of moderate revenue growth more acceptable to market participants. In addition, when we computed values under the various approaches, there was significantly less disparity between our DCF Model and Market Model estimates in the Housewares reporting unit than the disparities that existed in the Personal Care reporting units.  Accordingly, we believed the higher weighting afforded the Housewares DCF Model estimates was relevant and appropriate in describing its relative contribution to the Company’s overall fair market value.

 

Management believes that a significant portion of the decline in the Company’s common stock price in the period of time surrounding February 28, 2009 is related to the deterioration in general economic conditions, a loss of consumer confidence, and instability in the financial markets, and is not reflective of the combined underlying future cash flows of the reporting units.  The analysis below shows the impact stock price fluctuations had on the Company’s estimated fair market value and compares this to the estimated fair market value of the common stock implied by the total estimated fair market value of all of the reporting units we used in our impairment analysis.

 

RANGE OF ESTIMATES OF FAIR VALUE OF HELEN OF TROY

(in thousands, except share values)

 

 

At
November 30,
2008

 

At
February 28,
2009

 

At
April 30,
2009

 

Implied By the Sum of the Fair Values of Each Reporting Unit

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Market price of Helen of Troy’s Stock (minority shareholder value)

 

$

15.66

 

$

10.04

 

$

15.95

 

$

12.54

 

x Weighted average control premium (1)

 

30.2%

 

30.2%

 

30.2%

 

30.2%

 

Controlling interest value of Helen of Troy’s Stock

 

20.39

 

13.07

 

20.77

 

16.32

 

Number of shares outstanding at November 30, 2008 (2)

 

30,142

 

30,142

 

30,142

 

30,142

 

Controlling interest value of Helen of Troy’s Equity

 

614,575

 

394,019

 

625,956

 

492,000

 

Outstanding debt at November 30, 2008

 

212,000

 

212,000

 

212,000

 

212,000

 

Indicated fair market value of Helen of Troy

 

$

826,575

 

$

606,019

 

$

837,956

 

$

704,000

 

 

(1)        The relative weighted average of the median control premiums for each reporting unit, financial buyers only, using comparable industry information from current published control premium studies

 

(2)        This is the latest balance of outstanding shares that would have been used by market participants as reported on Form 10Q for the fiscal quarter ended November 30, 2008.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2009 - The Company performed its annual impairment tests of its goodwill and trademarks during the first quarter of fiscal 2009.  This resulted in non-cash impairment charges of $7.76 million ($7.61 million after tax) on certain intangible assets associated with our Personal Care segment recognized during the first quarter of fiscal 2009.  The charges were recorded in the Company’s consolidated statements of income as a component of operating income (loss).  The impairment charges reflected the amounts by which the carrying values of the associated assets exceeded their estimated fair values at the time of the analysis.  The fair values of the assets were primarily determined using DCF Models.  The decline in the fair value of the affected trademarks described above resulted from lower sales expectations on certain lower volume brands as a result of management’s strategic decision to reduce advertising and other resources dedicated to those brands, combined with a lower overall expectation of net sales revenue driven by our near-term outlook for the economy and projected declines in consumer retail spending levels.

 

Impairments in the Third Quarter of Fiscal 2008 - In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, we re-introduced the newly formulated Epil-Stop® product line.  During the second and third quarters of fiscal 2008, our Epil-Stop® brand of

 

46



Table of Contents

 

hair depilatory products lost placement in certain mass discount and drug channels due to low consumer response.  We experienced a high rate of customer sales returns for the product line.  In response to these circumstances, in the third quarter of fiscal 2008, we conducted a strategic review of the Epil-Stop® trademark. We also evaluated the future potential of our TimeBlock® brand in light of our recent experience with Epil-Stop®.  From these reviews, we concluded that the future undiscounted cash flows associated with these trademarks were insufficient to recover their carrying values.  We also believed that any significant additional investments in these brands would not generate potential returns in line with the Company’s investment expectations.  Accordingly, we recorded pre-tax impairment charges totaling $4.98 million ($4.88 million after tax) representing the carrying value of these trademarks.  We continue to hold these trademarks for use.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2008 - The Company performed its annual impairment tests of its goodwill and trademarks during the first quarter of fiscal 2008. No impairment charge was recorded during the first quarter of fiscal 2008 as the estimated fair value of the indefinite-lived trademarks and licenses, reporting unit net assets, and the Company’s estimated enterprise value exceeded their respective carrying values as of the date of the evaluation.

 

Gain on sale of land

 

On September 9, 2007, we sold 16.5 acres of raw land adjacent to our El Paso, Texas office and distribution center.  The land was sold for $6.00 million, less selling costs of $0.39 million and resulted in a pre-tax gain on the sale of $3.61 million.

 

Interest expense and Nonoperating income (expense):

 

Interest expense decreased to $10.31 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $13.69 million in fiscal 2009.  The decrease in interest expense was principally due to lower amounts of debt outstanding due to the scheduled retirement of $78.00 million of long-term debt during the year, when compared to fiscal 2009.  Interest expense decreased to $13.69 million in fiscal 2009 compared to $15.03 million in fiscal 2008.  The overall decrease was due to the retirement of $3.00 million of long-term debt during the year and the full year impact of $35.00 million of debt previously retired in the prior year.

 

Nonoperating income (expense) was $1.05, $2.44 and $3.75 million in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  The following schedule shows key components of nonoperating income (expense):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended (in thousands)

 

% of Sales Revenue, net (1)

 

% Change

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

10/09

 

09/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Nonoperating income (expense):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

$

566

 

$

2,719

 

$

3,573

 

 

0.1

%

0.4

%

0.5

%

 

-79.2

%

-23.9

%

Realized and unrealized gain (losses) on securities

 

420

 

(201

)

(189

)

 

0.1

%

0.0

%

0.0

%

 

*

 

6.3

%

Litigation settlement gain, net

 

-  

 

-  

 

104

 

 

0.0

%

0.0

%

0.0

%

 

0.0

%

*

 

Miscellaneous other income (expense), net

 

60

 

(80

)

260

 

 

0.0

%

0.0

%

0.0

%

 

*

 

*

 

Total nonoperating income (expense)

 

$

1,046

 

$

2,438

 

$

3,748

 

 

0.2

%

0.4

%

0.6

%

 

-57.1

%

-35.0

%

 

*    Calculation is not meaningful

 

(1) Sales percentages are computed as a percentage of total net sales revenue.

 

Interest income decreased to $0.57 million in fiscal 2010 compared to $2.72 million in fiscal 2009 due to a combination of lower average levels of investable funds on hand during fiscal 2010 and comparatively lower interest rates earned during the year when compared to fiscal 2009.

 

Interest income decreased to $2.72 million in fiscal 2009 compared to $3.57 million in fiscal 2008 due to our liquidation of $41.18 million of ARS and reinvestment of the funds into more liquid investments with comparatively lower interest rates and an overall decrease in interest rates available in financial markets.

 

47



Table of Contents

 

Income tax expense:

 

Our fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008 income tax expense (benefit) was $8.29, $5.33 and ($0.24) million, respectively.  In any given year, there may be significant transactions or events that are incidental to our core businesses and that by a combination of their nature and jurisdiction, can have a disproportionate impact on our reported effective tax rates.  Without these transactions, the trend in our effective tax rates would follow a more normalized pattern. The following table shows the comparative impact of these items on our pre-tax income (loss), tax expense and effective tax rates, for each of the years covered by this report:

 

IMPACT OF SIGNIFICANT ITEMS ON EFFECTIVE TAX RATES

(dollars in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of  February

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

 

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pre-tax income (loss) and tax expense (benefit), as reported

 

$   80,105

 

$   8,288

 

10.3%

 

$  (51,465

)

$    5,328

 

*

 

$61,273

 

($236

)

-0.4%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tax benefit from HK IRD Settlement, including interest

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

income and reversal of penalties

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

7,950

 

*

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tax benefit from IRS settlement, including interest and

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

penalties

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

461

 

*

 

-

 

1,363

 

*

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net operating loss valuation allowance

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(977

)

*

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

107,274

 

608

 

0.6%

 

4,983

 

100

 

2.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gain on sale of land

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(3,609

)

(1,364

)

37.8%

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gains on litigation settlements

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(104

)

(2

)

2.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charge to allowance for doubtful accounts due to customer bankruptcy

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

3,876

 

1,360

 

35.1%

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gains on casualty insurance settlements

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(2,702

)

(67

)

2.5%

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Pre-tax income and tax expense, without significant items

 

$   80,105

 

$   8,288

 

10.3%

 

$56,983

 

$7,690

 

13.5%

 

$62,543

 

$6,834

 

10.9%

 

 

*   Calculation is not meaningful

 

Excluding the impact of significant items, there is a trend of less of our income being taxed in higher tax rate jurisdictions, including the U.S.  Pre-tax income (loss) and tax expense without significant items are non-GAAP financial measures as contemplated by SEC Regulation G, Rule 100.  A reconciliation of these measures to their applicable GAAP-based measures is provided above, and an explanation of their nature and limitations, are furnished on pages 49 and 50.

 

48



Table of Contents

 

Net Income:

 

Our net income was $71.82 million for fiscal 2010 compared to a net loss of $56.79 million for fiscal 2009.  Our diluted earnings per share was $2.32 for fiscal 2010 compared to a diluted loss per share of ($1.88).  We believe that year- over-year comparisons are facilitated by the schedule shown in the table below which removes the net unfavorable impact of certain significant items in fiscal 2009, including: the effects of intangible asset impairment charges, a charge to bad debt associated with the Linens bankruptcy, the benefits of a tax settlement and a gain on casualty insurance settlements.  Excluding these 2009 items from the comparison, our net income without significant items increased $22.52 million or 45.7 percent when compared to fiscal 2009, and diluted earnings per share increased $0.73 to $2.32, as compared to $1.59 in fiscal 2009.

 

Net income in fiscal 2009 decreased by $118.30 million when compared to fiscal 2008.  In addition to a decline in net sales revenue and increasing cost of goods sold, a significant amount of this decline is due to the net unfavorable impact of significant items in fiscal 2009, including: the effects of intangible asset impairment charges, a charge to bad debt associated with the Linens bankruptcy, the benefits of a tax settlement and a gain on casualty insurance settlements.  This compares to the net favorable impact of significant items in fiscal 2008, including: the benefits of various tax settlements, a gain on a litigation settlement and a gain on the sale of land, partially offset by impairment charges and a tax valuation allowance on a net operating loss in Brazil.  Excluding these items from both years, fiscal 2009 net income decreased by $6.42 million or 11.5 percent when compared to fiscal 2008, and fiscal 2009 earnings per diluted share decreased to $1.59 as compared to $1.75 in fiscal 2008.  The remaining decline in income without significant items of $0.16 per diluted share is a result of the impact of global economic, and other factors referred to previously.

 

The following table shows the comparative impact of significant items on our net income (loss), and basic and diluted earnings per share for each of the years covered by this report:

 

IMPACT OF SIGNIFICANT ITEMS ON NET INCOME (LOSS) AND EARNINGS (LOSS) PER SHARE

(dollars in thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

Basic Earnings (Loss) Per Share

 

Diluted Earnings (Loss) Per Share

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2010

 

2009 [1]

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss) as reported

 

$

71,817

 

$

(56,793

)

$

61,509

 

 

$

2.38

 

$

(1.88

)

$

2.01

 

$

2.32

 

$

(1.88

)

$

1.93

 

Tax benefit of various tax settlements

 

-

 

(461

)

(9,313

)

 

-

 

(0.02

)

(0.31

)

-

 

(0.02

)

(0.29

)

Net operating loss valuation allowance

 

-

 

-

 

977

 

 

-

 

-

 

0.03

 

-

 

-

 

0.03

 

Asset impairment charges, net of taxes

 

-

 

106,666

 

4,883

 

 

-

 

3.54

 

0.16

 

-

 

3.50

 

0.15

 

Gain on sale of land, net of taxes

 

-

 

-

 

(2,245

)

 

-

 

-

 

(0.07

)

-

 

-

 

(0.07

)

Charge to allowance for doubtful accounts due to customer bankruptcy, net of taxes

 

-

 

2,516

 

-

 

 

-

 

0.08

 

-

 

-

 

0.08

 

-

 

Gain on litigation settlement, net of taxes

 

-

 

-

 

(102

)

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Gain on casualty insurance settlement,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

net of taxes

 

-

 

(2,635

)

-

 

 

-

 

(0.09

)

-

 

-

 

(0.09

)

-

 

Income without significant items

 

$

71,817

 

$

49,293

 

$

55,709

 

 

$

2.38

 

$

1.63

 

$

1.82

 

$

2.32

 

$

1.59

 

$

1.75

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares of common stock used in computing

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share, as reported

 

 

 

 

30,217

 

30,173

 

30,531

 

30,921

 

30,173

 

31,798

 

Basic and diluted earnings per share without significant items

 

 

 

 

30,217

 

30,173

 

30,531

 

30,921

 

31,019

 

31,798

 

 

[1] Dilutive shares used to compute earnings per share as reported in fiscal 2009 excludes the impact of options to purchase common stock as these would be anti-dilutive due to the net loss.

 

The tables shown above entitled “Impact of Significant Items on Effective Tax Rates” and “Impact of Significant Items on Net Income (Loss) and Earnings (Loss) per Share” report non-GAAP pre-tax income, tax expense, income and earnings per share data which exclude specified significant items.   Non-GAAP pre-tax income, tax expense, income and earnings per share data, as discussed in the preceding tables, are non-GAAP financial information as contemplated by SEC Regulation G, Rule 100. The preceding tables reconcile these measures to their corresponding GAAP-based measures presented in our consolidated statements of income. The Company believes that its non-GAAP pre-tax income, tax expense, income and earnings per share data provides useful information to management and investors regarding

 

49



Table of Contents

 

financial and business trends relating to its financial condition and results of operations.  The Company believes that this non-GAAP pre-tax income, tax expense, income and earnings per share data, in combination with the Company’s financial results calculated in accordance with GAAP, provides investors with additional perspective regarding the impact of certain significant items on pre-tax income (loss), tax expense, net income (loss) and earnings per share.  The Company also believes that these non-GAAP measures facilitate a more direct comparison of its performance with its competitors.  The Company further believes that the excluded significant items do not accurately reflect the underlying performance of its continuing operations for the period in which they are incurred, even though some of these excluded items may be incurred and reflected in the Company’s GAAP financial results in the foreseeable future.  The material limitation associated with the use of non-GAAP financial measures is that non-GAAP measures do not reflect the full economic impact of the Company’s activities.  The Company’s non-GAAP pre-tax income, tax expense, income and earnings per share data is not prepared in accordance with GAAP, is not an alternative to GAAP financial information and may be calculated differently than non-GAAP financial information disclosed by other companies.  Accordingly, undue reliance should not be placed on non-GAAP information.

 

FINANCIAL CONDITION, LIQUIDITY, AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

 

Selected measures of our liquidity and capital resources for fiscal years ended 2010 and 2009 are shown below:

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts Receivable Turnover (Days) (1)

 

65.3

 

68.3

 

Inventory Turnover (Times) (1)

 

2.5

 

2.3

 

Working Capital (in thousands)

 

$254,060

 

$233,218

 

Current Ratio

 

 3.4 : 1

 

 2.4 : 1

 

Ending Debt to Ending Equity Ratio (2)

 

23.0%

 

41.7%

 

Return on Average Equity (1)

 

13.2%

 

-10.0%

 

 

(1)            Accounts receivable turnover, inventory turnover, and return on average equity computations use 12 month trailing net sales revenue, cost of goods sold or net income components as required by the particular measure.   The current and four prior quarters’ ending balances of accounts receivable, inventory, and equity are used for the purposes of computing the average balance component as required by the particular measure.

 

(2)          Debt is defined as all debt outstanding at the balance sheet date.  This includes the sum of the following lines on our consolidated balance sheets: “Long-term debt, current maturities” and “Long-term debt, excluding current maturities.”  For further information regarding this financing, see Notes (6) and (8) to our consolidated financial statements and our discussion below under “Financing Activities.”

 

Operating Activities:

 

Operating activities provided $152.10 million of cash during fiscal 2010 compared with $21.93 million in fiscal 2009.  The increase in operating cash flow was principally due to the combination of higher net income in fiscal 2010 compared to fiscal 2009, after excluding the impact of non-cash impairment charges from both 2010 and 2009,  lower inventory and higher accounts payable and accrued expenses at the end of fiscal 2010 when compared to the same balances at end of fiscal 2009.

 

In fiscal 2010, our accounts receivable increased $6.17 million to $109.72 million while our accounts receivable turnover improved to 65.3 days from 68.3 days in fiscal 2009.  This calculation is based on a rolling five quarter accounts receivable balance.

 

Inventories decreased $45.76 million to $124.02 million at the end of fiscal 2010 when compared to $169.78 million at the end of fiscal 2009.  Ending fiscal 2009 inventories were much higher than normal due to weak sales in the second half of fiscal 2009.  Particularly, in the third quarter of fiscal 2009, retailers reduced their inventories to

 

50



Table of Contents

 

historically low levels in anticipation of a weak and promotional holiday selling season.   It was our plan, as stated in our annual report for fiscal 2009, to reduce our inventories from 2009 levels throughout fiscal 2010 and we believe we executed well against this plan.

 

Working capital increased to $254.06 million at the end of fiscal 2010, compared to $233.22 million at the end of fiscal 2009.  Our current ratio increased to 3.4:1 at the end of fiscal 2010, compared to 2.4:1 at the end of fiscal 2009. The increase in our working capital and current ratio was primarily caused by positive cash provided by operating activities during fiscal 2010 and the payoff of our $75 million, 5 year Senior Notes that matured in June 2009, which were classified as a current liability at February 28, 2009, partially offset by a reduction in inventories.

 

Operating activities provided $21.93 million of cash during fiscal 2009 compared with $109.91 million in fiscal 2008.  The decrease in operating cash flow was due to the combination of lower net income after adding back non-cash impairment charges, higher inventory and lower accounts payable and accrued liabilities.

 

Investing Activities:

 

In fiscal 2010, investing activities used $66.43 million of cash compared with $32.38 million provided in fiscal 2009 and $47.32 million used in fiscal 2008.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2010 investing activities:

 

·                  We spent $2.67 million on molds and tooling, $3.59 million on information technology infrastructure, including $2.46 million principally to purchase additional ERP software licenses.

 

·                  We used $60.00 million of cash to acquire certain assets, trademarks, customer lists, distribution rights, patents, goodwill, and formulas of the Infusium hair care products line for our Personal Care segment.

 

·                  We sold substantially all of our trading securities, generating $1.00 million in cash, and liquidated $0.25 million of ARS at par.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2009 investing activities:

 

·                  We spent $1.51 million on molds and tooling, $1.09 million on information technology infrastructure and $2.11 million on building improvements, primarily for new office space for our Housewares segment.

 

·                  We spent $4.77 million to acquire the Ogilvie trademark for our Personal Care segment.

 

·                  We liquidated $41.18 million of investments in ARS at par, leaving ARS at a net value of $19.97 million on hand at year end.

 

·                  We received net proceeds from the sale of property, plant and equipment, primarily from the sale of fractional shares in two corporate jets, of approximately $2.61 million.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2008 investing activities:

 

·                  We spent $1.74 million on molds and tooling, $1.08 million on information technology infrastructure, $1.66 million on distribution center equipment and $1.53 million on land for future distribution center expansion in Southaven, Mississippi.

 

·                  We spent $36.50 million in cash to acquire accounts receivable, inventory, trademarks, goodwill and intangible assets of the Belson business.

 

·                  We received net proceeds from the sale of land of $5.61 million and a property insurance settlement of $0.94 million.

 

51



Table of Contents

 

·                  We purchased $178.28 million and sold $170.20 million of temporary investments, leaving $63.83 million of temporary investments on hand at year end.

 

Financing Activities:

 

During fiscal 2010, financing activities used $78.13 million of cash compared to $9.48 and $40.19 million used in fiscal 2009 and fiscal 2008, respectively.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2010 financing activities:

 

·                  We repaid $78 million of Senior Notes.

 

·                  We repurchased and retired 47,648 shares of common stock at a total purchase price of $0.42 million, for an $8.80 per share average price.

 

·                  Employees and directors exercised options to purchase 141,800 shares of common stock in cash transactions, providing $2.19 million of cash and related tax benefits.  Employees also purchased 28,782 shares of common stock through our employee stock purchase plan, providing $0.35 million of cash.

 

·                  In addition, options to purchase 2,000,000 shares of common stock were exercised during the year in non-cash transactions in which our chief executive officer tendered 1,438,109 shares of common stock having a market value of $30.15 million as payment of the exercise price and related federal tax obligations for the exercise of options.  The exercise of these options resulted in the payment of $7.17 million of related federal income and payroll taxes and resulted in $4.83 million in tax benefits.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2009 financing activities:

 

·                  In July 2008, we paid a $3 million principal installment on our fixed rate senior debt.

 

·                  Employees and directors exercised options to purchase 47,907 shares of common stock, providing $0.52 million in cash and related tax benefits.  Employees also purchased 30,743 shares of common stock through our employee stock purchase plan, providing $0.34 million of cash.

 

·                  We purchased and retired a total of 574,365 shares of common stock on the open market at a total purchase price of $7.42 million.

 

Significant highlights of our fiscal 2008 financing activities:

 

·                  In June 2007, we prepaid $25 million of our 5 year floating rate Senior Notes without penalty.

 

·                  In January 2008, we paid a $10 million principal installment on our fixed rate senior debt.

 

·                  Employees exercised options to purchase 156,675 shares of common stock, providing $2.75 million of cash and related tax benefits.  Employees also purchased 27,014 shares of common stock through our employee stock purchase plan providing $0.44 million of cash.

 

·                  Additional options to purchase 1,000,000 shares of common stock were exercised during the fiscal quarter ended August 31, 2007 in a non-cash transaction in which our chief executive officer tendered 728,500 shares of common stock having a market value of $20.27 million as payment of the exercise price and related federal tax obligations for the exercise of options.  The exercise of these options required $4.51 million to pay related federal income tax obligations and generated approximately $1.66 million of related tax benefits.

 

·                  We purchased and retired a total of 366,892 shares of common stock on the open market at a total purchase price of $5.73 million.

 

52



Table of Contents

 

Revolving Line of Credit Agreement and Other Debt Agreements:

 

We have a Revolving Line of Credit Agreement (“RCA”) with Bank of America, N.A. that provides for a total revolving commitment of up to $50 million, subject to certain limitations as discussed below.  For additional information regarding the terms and conditions of the RCA, see Note (6) to the accompanying consolidated financial statements of this annual report on Form 10-K.

 

As of February 28, 2010, we had an aggregate principal balance of $134 million of Senior Notes with varying maturities due through June 2014.  The outstanding balance of $75 million on our 5 year floating rate Senior Notes were repaid in June 2009.  A principal payment of $3 million was also made on our fixed rate, 7.24 percent Senior Note in July 2009.

 

All of our long term debt, including our Senior Notes, is unconditionally guaranteed by the parent company, Helen of Troy Limited, and/or certain subsidiaries on a joint and several basis.  Our RCA and other debt agreements require the maintenance of certain debt/EBITDA and interest coverage ratios, specify minimum consolidated net worth levels, and contain other customary covenants.  As of February 28, 2010, our debt agreements effectively limited our ability to incur more than $288.42 million of additional debt from all sources, including draws on our RCA.  Additionally, our debt agreements restrict us from incurring liens on any of our properties, except under certain conditions, and limits our ability to repurchase shares of our common stock.  As of February 28, 2010, we were in compliance with the terms of the RCA and our other debt agreements.

 

Contractual Obligations:

 

Our contractual obligations and commercial commitments, as of the end of fiscal 2010 were:

 

PAYMENTS DUE BY PERIOD - TWELVE MONTHS ENDED THE LAST DAY OF FEBRUARY

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2011

 

2012

 

2013

 

2014

 

2015

 

After

 

 

 

Total

 

1 year

 

2 years

 

3 years

 

4 years

 

5 years

 

5 years

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Term debt - fixed rate

 

$

9,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Term debt - floating rate (1)

 

125,000

 

-

 

50,000

 

-

 

-

 

75,000

 

-

 

Long-term incentive plan payouts

 

4,958

 

2,339

 

1,505

 

1,114

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Interest on fixed rate debt

 

896

 

516

 

299

 

81

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Interest on floating rate debt (1)

 

23,459

 

7,453

 

5,489

 

4,507

 

4,507

 

1,503

 

-

 

Open purchase orders

 

76,716

 

76,716

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Minimum royalty payments

 

72,807

 

6,438

 

6,110

 

5,723

 

5,416

 

4,843

 

44,277

 

Advertising and promotional

 

80,625

 

8,712

 

6,146

 

6,168

 

5,559

 

5,328

 

48,712

 

Operating leases

 

11,795

 

2,023

 

1,721

 

1,416

 

1,348

 

1,267

 

4,020

 

Capital spending commitments

 

2,465

 

2,465

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total contractual obligations (2)

 

$

407,721

 

$

109,662

 

$

74,270

 

$

22,009

 

$

16,830

 

$

87,941

 

$

97,009

 

 

(1) The Company uses interest rate hedge agreements (the “swaps”)  in conjunction with its unsecured floating interest rate $50 million, 7 year and $75 million, 10 year Senior Notes.  The swaps are a hedge of the variable LIBOR rates used to reset the floating rates on these Senior Notes.  The swaps effectively fix the interest rates on the 7 and 10 year Senior Notes at 5.89 and 6.01 percent, respectively.   Accordingly, the future interest obligations related to this debt have been estimated using these rates.

 

(2)  In addition to the contractual obligations and commercial commitments in the table above, as of February 28, 2010, we have recorded a provision for our uncertain tax positions of $2.56 million. We are unable to reliably estimate the timing of future payments, if any, related to uncertain tax positions; therefore, we have excluded these tax liabilities from the table above.

 

53



Table of Contents

 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements:

 

We have no existing activities involving special purpose entities or off-balance sheet financing.

 

Current and Future Capital Needs:

 

At February 28, 2010, we held $20.53 million of our investments in ARS collateralized by student loans.  At this time, there is very limited demand for these securities and limited acceptable alternatives to liquidate such securities.  As a result, we may not be able to liquidate these ARS at their recorded values in the short to intermediate term.  If we are unable to sell the ARS on a timely basis as cash needs arise, we would be required to rely on cash on hand, cash from operations and available amounts under our Revolving Line of Credit Agreement in order to meet those needs.  For more information, see Item 1A., “Risk Factors.”

 

As further discussed elsewhere in this report and in Note (20) to the accompanying consolidated financial statements, on March 31, 2010, we completed the acquisition of certain assets and liabilities of the Pert Plus hair care and Sure anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC for a net cash purchase price of $69 million (subject to certain potential post acquisition-adjustments), which we paid with cash on hand.

 

Based on our current financial condition and current operations, we believe that cash flows from operations and available financing sources, including our RCA, will continue to provide sufficient capital resources to fund our foreseeable short- and long-term liquidity requirements.  We expect our capital needs to stem primarily from the need to purchase sufficient levels of inventory and to carry normal levels of accounts receivable on our balance sheet. In addition, we continue to evaluate acquisition opportunities on a regular basis and may augment our internal growth with acquisitions of complementary businesses or product lines. We may finance acquisition activity with available cash, the issuance of shares of common stock, additional debt or other sources of financing, depending upon the size and nature of any such transaction and the status of the capital markets at the time of such acquisition.

 

The Company may elect to repurchase additional shares of common stock from time to time based upon its assessment of its liquidity position and market conditions at the time, and subject to limitations contained in its debt agreements.  For additional information, see Part II, Item 2., “Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds.”

 

CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

The SEC defines critical accounting policies as those that are both most important to the portrayal of a company’s financial condition and results, and require management’s most difficult, subjective or complex judgments, often as a result of the need to make estimates about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain.  We consider the following policies to meet this definition.

 

Income Taxes - Effective March 1, 2007, we adopted  certain provisions of ASC Topic 740, “Income Taxes” (previously reported as FASB Interpretation No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109”), which provides guidance for the recognition, derecognition and measurement in financial statements of tax positions taken in previously filed tax returns or tax positions expected to be taken in tax returns.  See Note (9) - “Income Taxes” included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for further discussion.

 

We must make certain estimates and judgments in determining income tax expense for financial statement purposes. These estimates and judgments must be used in the calculation of certain tax assets and liabilities because of differences in the timing of recognition of revenue and expense for tax and financial statement purposes. We must assess the likelihood that we will be able to recover our deferred tax assets. If recovery is not likely, we must increase our provision for taxes by recording a valuation allowance against the deferred tax assets that we estimate will not ultimately be recoverable. As changes occur in our assessments regarding our ability to recover our deferred tax assets, our tax provision is increased in any period in which we determine that the recovery is not probable.

 

54



Table of Contents

 

In addition, the calculation of our tax liabilities requires us to account for uncertainties in the application of complex tax regulations. We recognize liabilities for uncertain tax positions based on the two-step process prescribed within the topic. The first step is to evaluate the tax position for recognition by determining if the weight of available evidence indicates that it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on audit based upon its technical merits, including resolution of related appeals or litigation processes, if any.  The second step requires us to estimate and measure the tax benefit as the largest amount that has greater than a 50 percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement. It is inherently difficult and subjective to estimate such amounts, as this requires us to determine the probability of various possible outcomes. We reevaluate these uncertain tax positions on a quarterly basis. This evaluation is based on factors including, but not limited to, changes in facts or circumstances, changes in tax law, effectively settled issues under audit, historical experience with similar tax matters, guidance from our tax advisors, and new audit activity.  A change in recognition or measurement would result in the recognition of a tax benefit or an additional charge to the tax provision in the period in which the change occurs.

 

Estimates of credits to be issued to customers - We regularly receive requests for credits from retailers for returned products or in connection with sales incentives, such as cooperative advertising and volume rebate agreements. We reduce sales or increase SG&A, depending on the nature of the credits, for estimated future credits to customers. Our estimates of these amounts are based either on historical information about credits issued, relative to total sales, or on specific knowledge of incentives offered to retailers.  This process entails a significant amount of subjectivity and uncertainty.

 

Valuation of inventory - We account for our inventory using a first-in, first-out system in which we record inventory on our balance sheet at the lower of its average cost or its net realizable value. Determination of net realizable value requires us to estimate the point in time at which an item’s net realizable value drops below its cost. We regularly review our inventory for slow-moving items and for items that we are unable to sell at prices above their original cost. When we identify such an item, we reduce its book value to the net amount that we expect to realize upon its sale. This process entails a significant amount of inherent subjectivity and uncertainty.

 

Goodwill and Indefinite-Lived Intangibles – As a result of acquisitions, the Company has significant intangible assets on its balance sheet that include goodwill and indefinite-lived intangibles (primarily trademarks and licenses).  Accounting for business combinations requires the use of estimates and assumptions in determining the fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed in order to properly allocate the purchase price. The estimates of the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed are based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable using established valuation techniques that consider a number of factors, and when appropriate, valuations performed by independent third party appraisers.

 

We consider whether circumstances or conditions exist which suggest that the carrying value of our goodwill and other long-lived assets might be impaired. If such circumstances or conditions exist, further steps are required in order to determine whether the carrying value of each of the individual assets exceeds its fair market value. If analysis indicates that an individual asset’s carrying value does exceed its fair market value, the next step is to record a loss equal to the excess of the individual asset’s carrying value over its fair value. The steps entail significant amounts of judgment and subjectivity.  We complete our analysis of the carrying value of our goodwill and other intangible assets during the first quarter of each fiscal year, or more frequently whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying value may not be recoverable.

 

The Company’s impairment test methodology uses DCF Models combined with other methods that provide additional observable market information which management believes best reflects the current risk level being incorporated into market prices.  The additional methods help to corroborate the fair values of each of the Company’s reporting units.  These other methods include the Subject Company Stock Price Method, the Guideline Public Company Method, and the Mergers and Acquisitions Method (together, the “Market Models”).  DCF Models use a number of assumptions including expected future cash flows from the assets, volatility, risk free rate, and the expected life of the assets.  In determining the assumptions to be used, the Company considers, among other things, the existing rates on Treasury Bills, yield spreads on assets with comparable expected lives, historical volatility of the Company’s common stock and that of comparable companies and general economic and industry trends.  The Subject Company Stock Price Method uses the same revenue and earnings valuation multiples embedded in the Company’s common stock price,

 

55



Table of Contents

 

including an appropriate control premium, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.   The Guideline Public Company Method uses a composite of revenue and earnings multiples derived as of the valuation date from a group of publicly traded companies that are in similar lines of business and serving similar distribution channels as a basis for estimating the separate values, including appropriate control premiums for each of the Company’s reporting units.  The Mergers and Acquisitions Method uses the revenue and earnings multiples embedded in a group of representative business acquisition transactions, to the extent that comparable transactions are available, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.  For each of the methods used, considerable management judgment is necessary in reaching a conclusion regarding the reasonableness of fair value estimates, evaluating the most likely impact of a range of possible external conditions, considering the resulting operating changes and their impact on estimated future cash flows,  determining the appropriate discount factors to use, and selecting and weighting appropriate comparable market level inputs.

 

After determining the fair value of our reporting units using the DCF Models and the Market Models, the Company assigns weights to the valuation methods used based on management’s assessment of the extent to which the economic environment affects each reporting unit’s value.  Management believes that each method used has relative merits and that by using multiple methods, particularly in times of economic uncertainty, a better estimate of fair value is determined.  Current accounting literature defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.  In applying weights to the various methods, the Company believes that its DCF Models capture management’s estimate regarding the results of its future prospects and its internal valuation for each reporting unit.  However, we also consider whether there is a divergence between management’s expectations for its reporting units’ prospects and the market’s expectations based on observable market information.  Because fair value needs to consider the value of a company from both the buy side and the sell side of a potential transaction, the weights we assigned to the DCF Models and the Market Models in any given period attempt to balance this divergence in points of view.   The weightings we assign attempt to recognize the appropriate risk premiums the market has assigned to each reporting unit.  Future weightings assigned to the various valuation methods may change as a result of changes in our business or market conditions.

 

If we determine that the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value indicating that goodwill, if any is impaired, we will also review the fair values of the reporting unit’s indefinite-lived intangibles for potential impairment.  The review uses the lower of:  (1) the carrying value; or (2) the fair value using DCF Models under the relief from royalty method for trademarks, or using DCF Models under the excess earnings method for indefinite-lived licenses.  The discount rate utilized to value our indefinite-lived assets is higher than the associated reporting unit’s market participant discount rate in order to reflect the higher rate of return that would likely be required when the associated trademark or license is sold as a separate asset.

 

The Company continues to monitor its reporting units for any triggering events or other signs of impairment.  Events and changes in circumstances that may indicate that there is impairment include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions to exit a business or dispose of an asset made in response to changes in economic, political and competitive conditions, the impact of the economic environment on our customer base and on broad market conditions that drive valuation considerations by market participants, our internal expectations with regard to future revenue growth and the assumptions we make when performing our impairment reviews, a significant decrease in the market price of our assets, a significant adverse change in the extent or manner in which our assets are used, a significant adverse change in legal factors or the business climate that could affect our assets, an accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition of an asset, and significant changes in the cash flows associated with an asset.  We analyze these assets at the individual asset, reporting unit and Company levels. For both the goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets in its reporting units, the recoverability of these amounts is dependent upon achievement of the Company’s projections and the continued execution of key initiatives related to revenue growth and improved profitability.  The rates used in our projections are management’s estimate of the most likely results over time, given a wide range of potential outcomes. The assumptions and estimates used in our impairment testing involve significant elements of subjective judgment and analysis by the Company’s management. While we believe that the assumptions we use are reasonable at the time made, changes in business conditions or other unanticipated events and circumstances may occur that cause actual results to differ materially from projected results and this could potentially require future adjustments to our asset valuations.

 

56



Table of Contents

 

Carrying value of other long-lived assets - We consider whether circumstances or conditions exist that suggest that the carrying value of a long-lived asset might be impaired. If such circumstances or conditions exist, further steps are required in order to determine whether the carrying value of the asset exceeds its fair market value. If analysis indicates that the asset’s carrying value does exceed its fair market value, the next step is to record a loss equal to the excess of the asset’s carrying value over its fair value. The steps entail significant amounts of judgment and subjectivity.

 

Economic useful life of intangible assets - We amortize intangible assets, such as licenses, trademarks, customer lists and distribution rights over their economic useful lives, unless those assets’ economic useful lives are indefinite. If an intangible asset’s economic useful life is deemed to be indefinite, that asset is not amortized. When we acquire an intangible asset, we consider factors such as the asset’s history, our plans for that asset, and the market for products associated with the asset. We consider these same factors when reviewing the economic useful lives of our previously acquired intangible assets as well. We review the economic useful lives of our intangible assets at least annually. The determination of the economic useful life of an intangible asset requires a significant amount of judgment and entails significant subjectivity and uncertainty. We complete our analysis of the remaining useful economic lives of our intangible assets during the first quarter of each fiscal year.

 

For a more comprehensive list of our accounting policies, we encourage you to read Note (1) included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  Note (1) describes several other policies, including policies governing the timing of revenue recognition, that are important to the preparation of our consolidated financial statements, but do not meet the SEC’s definition of critical accounting policies because they do not involve subjective or complex judgments.

 

NEW ACCOUNTING GUIDANCE

 

Refer to Note (1) in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for a discussion of new accounting pronouncements and the potential impact to our consolidated results of operations and financial position.

 

57



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

Changes in currency exchange rates, interest rates and the liquidity of our investments are our primary financial market risks.

 

Foreign Currency Risk:

 

Our functional currency is the U.S. Dollar. By operating internationally, we are subject to foreign currency risk from transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar.  Such transactions include sales, certain inventory purchases and operating expenses. As a result of such transactions, portions of our cash, trade accounts receivable, and trade accounts payable are denominated in foreign currencies.  For the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, 14.8, 16.9 and 16.8 percent of our net sales revenue was in foreign currencies.  These sales were primarily denominated in the British Pound, Euro, Mexican Peso, Canadian Dollar, Brazilian Real, Chilean Pesos, Peruvian Soles and Venezuelan Bolivares Fuertes. We make most of our inventory purchases from the Far East and use the U.S. Dollar for such purchases.  In our consolidated statements of income, exchange gains and losses resulting from the remeasurement of foreign taxes receivable, taxes payable, deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities, are recognized in their respective income tax lines, and all other foreign exchange gains and losses are recognized in SG&A.

 

We identify foreign currency risk by regularly monitoring our foreign currency-denominated transactions and balances.  Where operating conditions permit, we reduce foreign currency risk by purchasing most of our inventory with U.S. Dollars and by converting cash balances denominated in foreign currencies to U.S. Dollars.

 

We have historically hedged against certain foreign currency exchange rate-risk by using a series of forward contracts designated as cash flow hedges to protect against the foreign currency exchange risk inherent in our forecasted transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar.  In these transactions, we execute a forward currency contract that will settle at the end of a forecasted period.  Because the size and terms of the forward contract are designed so that its fair market value will move in the opposite direction and approximate magnitude of the underlying foreign currency’s forecasted exchange gain or loss during the forecasted period, a hedging relationship is created.  To the extent that we forecast the expected foreign currency cash flows from the period we enter into the forward contract until the date it will settle with reasonable accuracy, we significantly lower or materially eliminate a particular currency’s exchange risk exposure over the life of the related forward contract.  We enter into these types of agreements where we believe we have meaningful exposure to foreign currency exchange risk and the hedge pricing appears reasonable.  It is not practical for us to hedge all our exposures, nor are we able to project in any meaningful way the possible effect and interplay of all foreign currency fluctuations on translated amounts or future net income.  This is due to our constantly changing exposure to various currencies, the fact that each foreign currency reacts differently to the U.S. Dollar, and the significant number of currencies involved. Accordingly, we will always be subject to foreign exchange rate-risk on exposures we have not hedged, and these risks may be material.  We do not enter into any forward exchange contracts or similar instruments for trading or other speculative purposes

 

Interest Rate Risk:

 

Interest on our long-term debt outstanding as of February 28, 2010 is both floating and fixed.  Fixed rates are in place on $9 million of Senior Notes at 7.24 percent and floating rates are in place on $125 million of Senior Notes, which reset as described in Note (8) to the accompanying consolidated financial statements, and have been effectively converted to fixed rate debt using the interest rate swaps, as described below.

 

Our levels of debt, certain additional draws against our RCA (whose interest rates can vary with the term of each draw), and the uncertainty regarding the level of future interest rates increase our risk profile.  We manage our floating rate debt using interest rate swaps.  As of February 28, 2010, we had two swaps that converted an aggregate notional principal of $125 million from floating interest rate payments under our 7 and 10 year Senior Notes to fixed interest rate payments at 5.89 and 6.01 percent, respectively.  In the swap transactions, we maintain two contracts to pay fixed rates of interest on an aggregate notional principal amount of $125 million at rates of 5.04 and 5.11 percent on our 7 and 10 year Senior Notes, respectively, while simultaneously receiving floating rate interest payments set at 0.25 percent as of February 28, 2010 on the same notional amounts.  The fixed rate side of the swap will not change over the life of the

 

58



Table of Contents

 

swap.  The floating rate payments are reset quarterly based on three month LIBOR.  The resets are concurrent with the interest payments made on the underlying debt. Changes in the spread between the fixed rate payment side of the swap and the floating rate receipt side of the swap offset 100 percent of the change in any period of the underlying debt’s floating rate payments.  These swaps are used to reduce the Company’s risk of increased interest costs; however, when interest rates drop significantly below the swap rates, we lose the benefit that our floating rate debt would provide, if not managed with swaps. The swaps are considered 100 percent effective.

 

The following table summarizes the fair values of our various derivative instruments at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009:

 

FAIR VALUES OF DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS IN THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

February 28. 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative

 

and Other

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notional

 

Assets,

 

Current

 

Liabilities,

 

Designated as hedging Instuments

 

Hedge Type

 

Term

 

Amount

 

Current

 

Liabilities

 

Noncurrent

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Pounds

 

Cash flow

 

10/2010- 2/2011

 

£

5,000

 

$

651

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Canadian

 

Cash flow

 

10/2010 - 12/2010

 

$

6,000

 

144

 

-

 

-

 

Subtotal

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

795

 

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

Cash flow

 

6/2011- 6/2014

 

$

125,000

 

-

 

4,951

 

7,070

 

Total fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

795

 

$

4,951

 

$

7,070

 

 

February 28. 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative

 

and Other

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notional

 

Assets,

 

Current

 

Liabilities,

 

Designated as hedging Instuments

 

Hedge Type

 

Term

 

Amount

 

Current

 

Liabilities

 

Noncurrent

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Pounds

 

Ordinary

 

5/2009 - 8/2009

 

£

4,000

 

$

2,117

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Dollars

 

Ordinary

 

5/2009 - 8/2009

 

$

7,011

 

(1,298

)

-

 

-

 

Subtotal

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

819

 

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

Cash flow

 

6/2009 - 6/2014

 

$

200,000

 

-

 

4,853

 

9,017

 

Total fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

819

 

$

4,853

 

$

9,017

 

 

Counterparty Credit Risk:

 

Financial instruments, including foreign currency contracts and interest rate swaps, expose us to counterparty credit risk for nonperformance.  We manage our exposure to counterparty credit risk through only dealing with counterparties who are substantial international financial institutions with significant experience using such derivative instruments.  Although our theoretical credit risk is the replacement cost at the then estimated fair value of these instruments, we believe that the risk of incurring credit risk losses is remote.

 

59



Table of Contents

 

Rate Sensitive Financial Instruments:

 

The following table shows the approximate potential fair value change in U.S. Dollars that would arise from a hypothetical adverse 10 percent change in certain market based rates underlying our Fixed Rate Long-Term Debt, ARS and Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts, and a 50 basis point decrease in the rates underlying our Interest Rate Swaps as of February 28, 2010 and 2009.

 

CHANGE IN FAIR VALUE DUE TO AN ADVERSE MOVE IN RELATED RATES

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

February 28, 2010

 

 

 

Face or

 

 

 

 

 

Estimated

 

 

 

Notional

 

Carrying

 

Fair

 

Change in

 

 

 

Amount

 

Value

 

Value

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fixed Rate Long-Term Debt (1)

 

$9,000

 

($9,000

)

($9,600

)

($37

)

Interest Rate Swaps (2)

 

$125,000

 

($12,022

)

($12,022

)

($1,787

)

Auction Rate Securities (3)

 

$22,400

 

$20,534

 

$20,534

 

($235

)

Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts - Pounds (4)

 

£5,000

 

$651

 

$651

 

($761

)

Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts - Canadian Dollars (4)

 

$6,000

 

$144

 

$144

 

($570

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

February 28, 2009

 

 

 

Face or

 

 

 

 

 

Estimated

 

 

 

Notional

 

Carrying

 

Fair

 

Change in

 

 

 

Amount

 

Value

 

Value

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fixed Rate Long-Term Debt (1)

 

$12,000

 

($12,000

)

($12,441

)

($122

)

Interest Rate Swaps (2)

 

$200,000

 

($13,870

)

($13,870

)

($2,777

)

Auction Rate Securities (3)

 

$22,650

 

$19,973

 

$19,973

 

($277

)

Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts (5)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1)  The underlying interest rates used as a basis for these estimates are rates quoted by our lenders on fixed rate notes of similar term and credit quality as of the balance sheet dates shown.

 

(2)  The underlying interest rates are based on current and future projections over the related lives of the underlying swap contracts of expected 3 month LIBOR rates.

 

(3)  The underlying market based rate is the credit spread between the 30 year Treasury Bill rate and an average of Moody’s AAA and BAA corporate rates.

 

(4)  At February 28, 2010, appreciation in the value of the U.S. Dollar would result in an increase in the fair value of the related foreign currency contracts.

 

(5)  Our Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts at February 28, 2009 included contracts to sell British Pounds in exchange for U.S. Dollars offset by other later executed contracts to sell U.S. Dollars in exchange for British Pounds.  The newer contracts have the effect of eliminating the foreign currency hedge created by the original contracts.  Any move in currency rates that would be adverse to one set of contracts will be effectively cancelled by its corresponding favorable impact on the other set of contracts.

 

The table above is for risk analysis purposes and does not purport to represent actual losses or gains in fair value that we will incur.  It is important to note that the change in value represents the estimated change in the fair value of the contracts.  Actual results in the future may differ materially from these estimated results due to actual developments in the global financial markets.  Because the contracts hedge an underlying exposure, we would expect a similar and opposite change in foreign exchange gains or losses and floating interest rates over the same periods as the contracts.

 

We expect that as currency market conditions warrant, and if our foreign denominated transaction exposure grows, we will continue to execute additional contracts in order to hedge against potential foreign exchange losses.

 

60



Table of Contents

 

Risks Inherent in Cash, Cash Equivalents and Investment Holdings:

 

Our cash, cash equivalents and investments are subject to interest rate risk, credit risk and liquidity risk.  Cash consists of both interest-bearing and non interest-bearing disbursement or short-term investment accounts.  Cash equivalents consist of commercial paper and money market investment accounts.  Long-term investments consist of AAA rated ARS that we normally seek to dispose of within 35 or fewer days. The following table summarizes our cash, cash equivalents and long-term investments at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009:

 

CASH, CASH EQUIVALENTS AND LONG-TERM INVESTMENTS

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

February 28, 2010

 

February 28, 2009

 

 

 

Carrying

 

Range of

 

Carrying

 

Range of

 

 

 

Amount

 

Interest Rates

 

Amount

 

Interest Rates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash, interest and non interest-bearing accounts - unrestricted

 

$

6,234

 

0.00 to 2.00%

 

$

18,575

 

0.00 to 3.00%

 

Cash, interest and non interest-bearing accounts - restricted

 

1,053

 

0.00 to 2.50%

 

1,426

 

0.00 to 7.00%

 

Commercial paper

 

88,822

 

0.03 to 0.18%

 

-

 

-

 

Money market funds

 

14,099

 

0.01 to 3.98%

 

82,674

 

0.35 to 6.00%

 

Total cash and cash equivalents

 

$

110,208

 

 

 

$

102,675

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term investments - auction rate securities

 

$

20,534

 

1.73 to 8.44%

 

$

19,973

 

1.95 to 8.67%

 

 

Our cash balances at end of fiscal 2010 and 2009 include restricted cash of $1.05 and $1.43 million, respectively, denominated in Venezuelan Bolivares Fuertes, shown above under the heading “Cash held in interest and non interest-bearing accounts – restricted.” The balances are primarily a result of favorable operating cash flows within the Venezuelan market.  Due to continued Venezuelan government restrictions on transfers of cash out of the country and control of exchange rates, the Company has not yet received approval of its applications to repatriate this cash at an official exchange rate, and currently intends to use these balances to remain in-country and fund operations until such time as our applications are approved.  We do not otherwise rely on these restricted funds as a source of liquidity.

 

On January 8, 2010, the Venezuelan government announced its decision to devalue its currency and implement a two-tier exchange rate structure. As a result, the official exchange rate changed from 2.15 to 2.60 for essential goods and 4.30 for non-essential goods. We believe that our products are classified as non-essential goods and thus payments made for such goods are exchanged at the 4.30 rate.  In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2010, we remeasured the financial statements of our Venezuelan subsidiary at the rate at which we expect to remit dividends, which currently is 4.30. The $1.26 million impact of the devaluation was included in SG&A in fiscal 2010.  The Venezuelan government continues to impose currency exchange controls. We could be negatively affected if we are unable to obtain U.S. Dollars at either of the official rates, in which case we may have to obtain U.S. Dollars through transactions on the parallel market, where the exchange rate is even less favorable than the non-essential goods rate. In fiscal 2010, our Venezuelan operations contributed 1.23 percent of consolidated net sales revenue.  As a result, we currently do not expect the impact of future devaluations to be material to our overall operations.

 

Most of our cash equivalents and investments are in money market accounts and ARS with frequent rate resets; therefore, we believe there is no material interest rate risk.  In addition, our commercial paper and ARS are from issuers with high credit ratings; therefore, we believe the credit risk is relatively low.

 

We hold investments in ARS collateralized by student loans (with underlying maturities from 19 to 36 years).  Substantially all of the collateral is guaranteed by the U.S. government under the Federal Family Education Loan Program.  Liquidity for these securities was normally dependent on an auction process that reset the applicable interest rate at pre-determined intervals, ranging from 7 to 35 days.  Beginning in February 2008, the auctions for the ARS held by us and others were unsuccessful, requiring us to hold them beyond their typical auction reset dates. Auctions fail when there is insufficient demand.  However, this does not represent a default by the issuer of the security. Upon an auction’s failure, the interest rates reset based on a formula contained in the security.  The securities will continue to accrue interest and be auctioned until one of the following occurs: the auction succeeds; the issuer calls the securities; or the securities mature.

 

61



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

 

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE

 

 

PAGE

 

 

 

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

63

 

 

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

64

 

 

Consolidated Financial Statements:

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of February 28, 2010 and 2009

66

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Income for each of the years in the three-year period ended February 28, 2010

67

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for each of the years in the three-year period ended February 28, 2010

68

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended February 28, 2010

69

 

 

 

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

70

 

 

 

Financial Statement Schedule:

 

 

Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for each of the years in the three-year period ended February 28, 2010

110

 

All other schedules are omitted as the required information is included in the consolidated financial statements or is not applicable.

 

62



Table of Contents

 

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

Helen of Troy’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined by Rules 13a-15(f) or 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act.

 

Our internal control system is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and includes those policies and procedures that:

 

·                  pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect our transactions and dispositions of assets;

 

·                  provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and Board of Directors; and

 

·                  provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

There are inherent limitations in the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility that misstatements may not be prevented or detected.  Furthermore, the effectiveness of internal controls may become inadequate because of future changes in conditions, or variations in the degree of compliance with our policies or procedures.

 

Our management assesses the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting using the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control-Integrated Framework.  Based on our assessment, we concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of February 28, 2010.

 

Our independent registered public accounting firm, Grant Thornton LLP, has issued an audit report on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.  This report appears on page 64.

 

63



Table of Contents

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of

Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries

 

We have audited Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries’ (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of February 28, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

In our opinion, Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of February 28, 2010, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by COSO.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of the Company as of February 28, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of income, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended February 28, 2010, and financial statement schedule for the three years in the period ended February 28, 2010, and our report dated May 13, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements and financial statement schedule.

 

 

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP

Dallas, Texas

May 13, 2010

 

64



Table of Contents

 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of

Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of February 28, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of income, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended February 28, 2010. Our audits of the basic financial statements included the financial statement schedule titled Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts listed in the index appearing under Item 8 as it relates to the three years in the period ended February 28, 2010. These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries as of February 28, 2010 and 2009, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended February 28, 2010, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  Also in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Helen of Troy Limited and Subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of February 28, 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) and our report dated May 13, 2010 expressed an unqualified opinion.

 

 

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP

Dallas, Texas

May 13, 2010

 

65



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets
(in thousands, except shares and par value)

 

 

 

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

Asset, current:

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

$

110,208

 

$

102,675

 

Trading securities, at market value

 

-

 

570

 

Derivative assets, current

 

795

 

819

 

Receivables - principally trade, less allowances of $3,346 and $3,756

 

109,722

 

103,548

 

Inventory, net

 

124,021

 

169,780

 

Prepaid expenses

 

2,485

 

2,819

 

Income taxes receivable

 

597

 

4,051

 

Deferred tax assets, net

 

11,526

 

13,010

 

Total assets, current

 

359,354

 

397,272

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $58,464 and $51,607

 

82,113

 

83,946

 

Goodwill

 

185,937

 

166,131

 

Other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization of $33,449 and $27,321

 

177,124

 

143,660

 

Deferred tax assets, net

 

-

 

1,618

 

Other assets, net of accumulated amortization of $3,825 and $3,447

 

30,205

 

29,499

 

Total assets

 

$

834,733

 

$

822,126

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities, current:

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable, principally trade

 

$

35,005

 

$

33,957

 

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

67,289

 

52,097

 

Long-term debt, current maturities

 

3,000

 

78,000

 

Total liabilities, current

 

105,294

 

164,054

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred compensation liability

 

3,833

 

3,459

 

Deferred tax liabilities, net

 

1,202

 

-

 

Long-term debt, excluding current maturities

 

131,000

 

134,000

 

Liability for uncertain tax positions

 

2,562

 

2,903

 

Derivative liabilities, noncurrent

 

7,070

 

9,017

 

Total liabilities

 

250,961

 

313,433

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

Cumulative preferred stock, non-voting, $1.00 par. Authorized 2,000,000 shares; none issued

 

-

 

-

 

Common stock, $0.10 par. Authorized 50,000,000 shares; 30,571,813 and 29,878,988 shares issued and outstanding

 

3,057

 

2,988

 

Additional paid in capital

 

120,761

 

105,627

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(8,574

)

(10,294

)

Retained earnings

 

468,528

 

410,372

 

Total stockholders’ equity

 

583,772

 

508,693

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

834,733

 

$

822,126

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

66



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Income

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

 

Years Ended The Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

Cost of goods sold

 

368,470

 

367,343

 

370,853

 

Gross profit

 

279,156

 

255,402

 

281,695

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative expense

 

188,887

 

188,344

 

207,771

 

Operating income before impairments and gain

 

90,269

 

67,058

 

73,924

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

900

 

107,274

 

4,983

 

Gain on sale of land

 

-    

 

-    

 

(3,609

)

Operating income (loss)

 

89,369

 

(40,216

)

72,550

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Nonoperating income (expense), net

 

1,046

 

2,438

 

3,748

 

Interest expense

 

(10,310

)

(13,687

)

(15,025

)

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

80,105

 

(51,465

)

61,273

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

8,288

 

5,328

 

(236

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

71,817

 

$

(56,793

)

$

61,509

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

2.38

 

$

(1.88

)

$

2.01

 

Diluted

 

$

2.32

 

$

(1.88

)

$

1.93

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares of common stock used in

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

computing net earnings (loss) per share:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

30,217

 

30,173

 

30,531

 

Diluted

 

30,921

 

30,173

 

31,798

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

67



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Additional

 

Other

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

Common Stock

 

Paid In

 

Comprehensive

 

Retained

 

Stockholders’

 

 

 

Shares

 

Dollars

 

Capital

 

Loss

 

Earnings

 

Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balances February 28, 2007

 

30,286

 

$

3,029

 

$

94,951

 

$

(1,566

)

$

431,003

 

$

527,417

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cumulative-effect adjustments, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adoption of FIN 48

 

-    

 

-    

 

(6,144

)

-    

 

(5,911

)

(12,055

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Components of comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

61,509

 

61,509

 

Unrealized losses on cash flow hedges - interest rate swaps, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(7,225

)

-    

 

(7,225

)

Unrealized gains on cash flow hedges - foreign currency, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

440

 

-    

 

440

 

Total comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

54,724

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Share-based compensation, net of tax benefits of $192

 

-    

 

-    

 

970

 

-    

 

-    

 

970

 

Effect of favorable tax settlements on prior years share-based compensation charges to paid-in-capital

 

-    

 

-    

 

2,321

 

-    

 

-    

 

2,321

 

Exercise of stock options, including tax benefits of $2,288

 

1,157

 

116

 

20,449

 

-    

 

-    

 

20,565

 

Issuance of common stock in connection with employee stock purchase plan

 

27

 

3

 

432

 

-    

 

-    

 

435

 

Common stock repurchased and retired

 

(1,095

)

(110

)

(12,651

)

-    

 

(13,240

)

(26,001

)

Balances February 29, 2008

 

30,375

 

3,038

 

100,328

 

(8,351

)

473,361

 

568,376

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cumulative-effect adjustments, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adoption of EITF 06-10

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(656

)

(656

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Components of comprehensive loss:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(56,793

)

(56,793

)

Unrealized losses on cash flow hedges - interest rate swaps, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(938

)

-    

 

(938

)

Unrealized gains on cash flow hedges - foreign currency, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

762

 

-    

 

762

 

Unrealized losses - auction rate securities, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(1,767

)

-    

 

(1,767

)

Total comprehensive loss, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(58,736

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Share-based compensation, net of tax benefits of $88

 

-    

 

-    

 

1,400

 

-    

 

-    

 

1,400

 

Effect of favorable tax settlements on prior years share-based compensation charges to paid-in-capital

 

-    

 

-    

 

4,634

 

-    

 

-    

 

4,634

 

Exercise of stock options, including tax benefits of $142

 

48

 

5

 

743

 

-    

 

-    

 

748

 

Issuance of common stock in connection with employee stock purchase plan

 

31

 

3

 

340

 

-    

 

-    

 

343

 

Common stock repurchased and retired

 

(575

)

(58

)

(1,818

)

-    

 

(5,540

)

(7,416

)

Balances February 28, 2009

 

29,879

 

2,988

 

105,627

 

(10,294

)

410,372

 

508,693

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Components of comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

71,817

 

71,817

 

Unrealized gains on cash flow hedges - interest rate swaps, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

1,220

 

-    

 

1,220

 

Unrealized losses on cash flow hedges - foreign currency, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(35

)

-    

 

(35

)

Unrealized gains - auction rate securities, net of tax

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

535

 

-    

 

535

 

Total comprehensive income, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

73,537

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjustments to paid in capital for changes uncertain tax positions

 

-    

 

-    

 

(258

)

-    

 

-    

 

(258

)

Share-based compensation, net of tax benefits of $87

 

-    

 

-    

 

1,657

 

-    

 

-    

 

1,657

 

Exercise of stock options, including tax benefits of $5,024

 

2,142

 

214

 

30,153

 

-    

 

-    

 

30,367

 

Issuance of restricted stock

 

8

 

1

 

(1

)

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

Issuance of common stock in connection with employee stock purchase plan

 

29

 

3

 

344

 

-    

 

-    

 

347

 

Common stock repurchased and retired

 

(1,486

)

(149

)

(16,761

)

-    

 

(13,661

)

(30,571

)

Balances February 28, 2010

 

30,572

 

$

3,057

 

$

120,761

 

$

(8,574

)

$

468,528

 

$

583,772

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

68



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended The Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

$

71,817

 

$

(56,793

)

$

61,509

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

15,261

 

14,185

 

14,298

 

Provision for doubtful receivables

 

448

 

5,643

 

1,411

 

Share-based compensation

 

1,744

 

1,488

 

1,162

 

Goodwill and intangible asset impairment charges

 

900

 

107,274

 

4,983

 

(Gains) loss on the sale of property and equipment

 

115

 

(56

)

(3,573

)

Realized and unrealized (gain) loss on investments

 

(417

)

252

 

189

 

Write off of deferred finance costs due to early extinguishment of debt

 

-    

 

-    

 

282

 

Deferred income taxes and tax credits

 

3,316

 

2,379

 

1,377

 

Changes in operating capital, net of effects of acquisition of businesses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Receivables

 

(6,622

)

(3,417

)

16,500

 

Inventories

 

45,653

 

(24,265

)

7,039

 

Prepaid expenses

 

334

 

3,471

 

903

 

Other assets

 

(476

)

(706

)

(408

)

Accounts payable

 

1,121

 

(8,806

)

4,968

 

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

15,775

 

(13,893

)

2,684

 

Accrued income taxes

 

3,130

 

(4,829

)

(3,418

)

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

152,099

 

21,927

 

109,906

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Capital, license, trademark, and other intangible expenditures

 

(7,715

)

(5,859

)

(7,709

)

Proceeds from the sale of property and equipment

 

45

 

2,613

 

5,702

 

Payments to acquire investments

 

(9

)

(786

)

(178,275

)

Proceeds from sale of investments

 

1,246

 

41,175

 

170,200

 

Payments to acquire businesses

 

(60,000

)

(4,765

)

(36,500

)

Other investing activities

 

-    

 

-    

 

(738

)

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

 

(66,433

)

32,378

 

(47,320

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Repayments of long-term debt

 

(78,000

)

(3,000

)

(35,000

)

Payments of financing costs

 

-    

 

(157

)

-    

 

Proceeds from exercise of stock options and employee stock purchases, net

 

7,365

 

859

 

4,854

 

Payment of tax obligations resulting from cashless option exercise

 

(7,166

)

-    

 

(4,505

)

Payments for repurchases of common stock

 

(419

)

(7,271

)

(5,731

)

Share-based compensation tax benefit

 

87

 

88

 

192

 

Net cash used in financing activities

 

(78,133

)

(9,481

)

(40,190

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

7,533

 

44,824

 

22,396

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning balance

 

102,675

 

57,851

 

35,455

 

Cash and cash equivalents, ending balance

 

$

110,208

 

$

102,675

 

$

57,851

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Supplemental cash flow information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest paid

 

$

10,781

 

$

13,057

 

$

14,969

 

Income taxes paid, net of refunds

 

$

(2,913

)

$

7,642

 

$

24,692

 

Value of common stock received as exercise price of options

 

$

23,261

 

$

146

 

$

15,938

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

69



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(in thousands of U.S. Dollars, except share and per share data, unless indicated otherwise)

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

(a)       General

 

When used in these notes, the terms “Helen of Troy,” “the Company,” “we”, “our” or “us” means Helen of Troy Limited, a Bermuda company, and its subsidiaries.  We refer to the Company’s common shares, par value $0.10 per share, as “common stock.”

 

We are a global designer, developer, importer, marketer and distributor of an expanding portfolio of brand-name consumer products.  We have two segments: Personal Care and Housewares.  Our Personal Care segment’s products include hair dryers, straighteners, curling irons, hairsetters, shavers, mirrors, hot air brushes, home hair clippers and trimmers, paraffin baths, massage cushions, footbaths, body massagers, brushes, combs, hair accessories, liquid and aerosol hair care and styling products, men’s fragrances, men’s deodorants, liquid and bar soaps, shampoos, hair treatments, foot powder, body powder and skin care products. Our Housewares segment reports our operations under the OXO® (“OXO”) family of brands whose products include kitchen tools, cutlery, bar and wine accessories, household cleaning tools, food storage containers, tea kettles, trash cans, storage and organization products, hand tools, gardening tools, kitchen mitts and trivets, barbeque tools, rechargeable lighting products, baby and toddler care products.   Both our Personal Care and Housewares segments sell their products primarily through mass merchandisers, drugstore chains, warehouse clubs, catalogs, grocery stores and specialty stores.  In addition, the Personal Care segment sells extensively through beauty supply retailers and wholesalers.  We purchase our products from unaffiliated manufacturers, most of which are located in the People’s Republic of China and the United States.

 

Our financial statements are prepared in U.S. Dollars and in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”).  GAAP as referred to herein, refers to the Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) issued by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“the FASB”) in June 2009 and made the single official source of U.S. GAAP (other than guidance issued by the Securities and Exchange Commission). The ASC supersedes existing FASB, American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) guidance and related literature.  GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses, and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

For both fiscal 2009 and fiscal 2008, we have reclassified certain amounts, and in some cases provided additional information in our consolidated financial statements and accompanying footnotes to conform to the current year’s presentation.  These reclassifications have no impact on previously reported net income (loss).

 

(b)       Consolidation

 

Our consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Helen of Troy Limited and its wholly-owned subsidiaries.  All intercompany accounts and transactions are eliminated in consolidation.

 

(c)       Cash and cash equivalents

 

Cash equivalents include all highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less. We maintain cash and cash equivalents at several financial institutions, which at times may not be federally insured or may exceed federally insured limits. We have not experienced any losses in such accounts and believe we are not exposed to any significant credit risks on such accounts.

 

We consider commercial paper and money market investment accounts to be cash equivalents.  Cash equivalents comprised $102.92 and $82.67 million of the amounts reported on our consolidated balance sheets as “Cash and cash equivalents” at February 28, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Note (11) contains additional information regarding our cash and cash equivalents.

 

70



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

(d)       Trading securities

 

Trading securities consist of shares of common stock of publicly traded companies and are stated on our consolidated balance sheets at market value, as determined by the most recent trading price of each security as of each balance sheet date.  We determine the appropriate classification of our investments when those investments are purchased and reevaluate those determinations at each balance sheet date.  Trading securities are currently included in the “Current assets” section of our consolidated balance sheets. All unrealized gains and losses attributable to such securities are included in “Nonoperating income (expense)” on the consolidated statements of income.

 

The sum of unrealized and realized net gains (losses) attributable to trading securities totaled $0.42, ($0.20) and ($0.19) million in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

(e)       Receivables

 

Our receivables are comprised principally of trade credit granted to customers, primarily in the retail industry, offset by two valuation reserves: an allowance for doubtful receivables and an allowance for back-to-stock returns.

 

Our allowance for doubtful receivables reflects our best estimate of probable losses, determined principally on the basis of historical experience and specific allowances for known troubled accounts. Our policy is to charge off receivables when we have determined they will no longer be collectible. Charge offs are applied as a reduction to the allowance for doubtful accounts and any recoveries of previous charge offs are netted against bad debt expense in the period recovered.   At February 28, 2010 and 2009, the allowance for doubtful receivables was $1.39 and $1.92 million, respectively.  The Company has significant concentrations of credit risk with two major customers.  In addition, as of February 28, 2010 and 2009, approximately 53 and 47 percent, respectively, of the Company’s gross trade receivables were due from its five top customers.

 

Our allowance for back-to-stock returns reflects our best estimate of future customer returns, determined principally on the basis of historical experience and specific allowances for known pending returns.  At February 28, 2010 and 2009, the allowance for back-to-stock returns was $1.96 and $1.84 million, respectively.

 

(f)         Inventory, net and cost of goods sold

 

Our inventory consists almost entirely of finished goods. We account for inventory using a first-in, first-out system in which we record inventory on our balance sheet at the lower of our average cost or net realizable value. A product’s average cost is comprised of the amount that we pay our manufacturer for product, tariffs and duties associated with transporting product across national borders, freight costs associated with transporting the product from our manufacturers to our distribution centers, and general and administrative expenses directly attributable to the procurement of inventory.

 

General and administrative expenses in inventory include all the expenses of operating the Company’s sourcing activities, expenses incurred for production monitoring, and expenses incurred for product design, engineering and packaging. We charged $9.68, $15.22 and $12.49 million of such general and administrative expenses to inventory during fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. We estimate that $4.01 and $6.35 million of general and administrative expenses directly attributable to the procurement of inventory were included in our inventory balances on hand at February 28, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

The “Cost of goods sold” line item on the consolidated statements of income is comprised of the book value (lower of average cost or net realizable value) of inventory sold to customers during the reporting period.  When circumstances dictate that we use net realizable value in lieu of cost, we base our estimates on expected future selling prices less expected disposal costs.

 

71


 


Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

For fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, cost of goods sold manufactured by vendors in the Far East comprised approximately 85, 88 and 88 percent, respectively, of total consolidated cost of goods sold.  Our mix between Far East and domestic manufacturing changed in fiscal 2010 as Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care solutions became a larger part of our business.  We have sourcing relationships with well over 200 third-party manufacturers.  During fiscal 2010, the top two manufacturers fulfilled approximately 28 percent of our product requirements.  Over the same period, our top five suppliers fulfilled approximately 42 percent of our product requirements.

 

(g)   Property and equipment

 

These assets are stated at cost. Depreciation is recorded on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Expenditures for repair and maintenance of property and equipment are expensed as incurred.  For tax purposes, accelerated depreciation methods are used as allowed by tax laws.

 

(h)       License agreements, trademarks, patents and other intangible assets

 

A significant portion of our consolidated sales are made subject to license agreements with the licensors of the Vidal Sassoon®, Revlon®, Sunbeam®, Health o meter®, Bed Head®, Toni&Guy®, Dr. Scholl’s®, Vitapointe® and Veet® trademarks. Our license agreements are reported on our consolidated balance sheets at cost, less accumulated amortization. The cost of our license agreements represents amounts paid to licensors to acquire the license or to alter the terms of the license in a manner that we believe to be in our best interest. Royalty payments are not included in the cost of license agreements. Royalty expense under our license agreements is recognized as incurred and is included in our consolidated statements of income on the line entitled “Selling, general, and administrative expense” (“SG&A”). We amortize license costs on a straight-line basis over the appropriate lives of the respective agreements. Net sales revenue subject to trademark license agreements comprised 36, 42 and 48 percent of total consolidated net sales revenue for fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

We also sell products under trademarks that we own. Trademarks that we acquire from other entities are generally recorded on our consolidated balance sheets based upon the appraised cost of acquiring the trademark, net of any accumulated amortization and impairment charges. Costs associated with developing trademarks internally are recorded as expenses in the period incurred. When trademarks have readily determinable useful lives, we amortize their costs on a straight-line basis over such lives. In certain instances, we have determined that particular trademarks have an indefinite useful life.  In these cases, no amortization is recorded.

 

Patents acquired through purchase from other entities, if material, are recorded on our consolidated balance sheets based upon the appraised cost of the acquired patents and amortized over the remaining life of the patent.  Additionally, we incur certain costs, primarily legal fees in connection with the design and development of products to be covered by patents, which are capitalized as incurred and amortized on a straight-line basis over the life of the patent in the jurisdiction filed, typically 14 years.

 

Other intangible assets include customer lists, distribution rights, patent rights and non-compete agreements that we acquired from other entities.  These are recorded on our consolidated balance sheets based upon the appraised cost of the acquired asset and amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining life of the asset as determined either through outside appraisal or the term of any controlling agreements. See Notes (4) and (5) to these consolidated financial statements for additional information on our intangible assets.

 

(i)           Goodwill, intangible and other long-lived assets and impairments

 

We complete our analysis of the carrying value of our goodwill and other intangible assets during the first quarter of each fiscal year, or more frequently whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that their carrying value may not be recoverable.

 

72



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

Goodwill is recorded as the difference, if any, between the aggregate consideration paid and the fair value of the net tangible and intangible assets received in the acquisition of a business.  We evaluate goodwill at the reporting unit level.  The performance of the test involves a two-step process.  The first step of the impairment test involves determining the fair value of each reporting unit and then comparing its fair value with its aggregate carrying value, including goodwill.  If the carrying amount of the reporting unit is greater than the fair value, an impairment may be present and we perform the second step of the goodwill impairment test to determine the amount of impairment loss.  In conjunction with the first step evaluation, the fair values of the individual reporting unit’s indefinite-lived intangibles are reviewed for potential impairment.  The second step of the goodwill impairment test involves comparing the implied fair value of the affected reporting unit’s goodwill with the carrying value of that goodwill.  We measure the amount of any goodwill impairment based upon the estimated fair value of the underlying assets and liabilities of the reporting unit, including any unrecognized intangible assets, and estimates of the implied fair value of goodwill.  An impairment charge is recognized to the extent the recorded goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of goodwill.

 

We consider whether circumstances or conditions exist which suggest that the carrying value of our goodwill and other long-lived assets might be impaired. If such circumstances or conditions exist, further steps are required in order to determine whether the carrying value of each of the individual assets exceeds its fair market value. If analysis indicates that an individual asset’s carrying value does exceed its fair market value, the next step is to record a loss equal to the excess of the individual asset’s carrying value over its fair value. These steps entail significant amounts of judgment and subjectivity.  Events and changes in circumstances that may indicate there is impairment include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions to exit a business or dispose of an asset made in response to changes in economic, political and competitive conditions, the impact of the economic environment on our customer base and on broad market conditions that drive valuation considerations by market participants, our internal expectations with regard to future revenue growth and the assumptions we make when performing our impairment reviews, a significant decrease in the market price of our assets, a significant adverse change in the extent or manner in which our assets are used, a significant adverse change in legal factors or the business climate that could affect our assets, an accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition of an asset, and significant changes in the cash flows associated with an asset.  We analyze these assets at the individual asset, reporting unit and Company levels.

 

As further discussed in Note (4) to these consolidated financial statements, we have recorded non-cash impairment charges totaling $0.90 million ($0.89 million after tax), $107.27 million ($106.67 million after tax) and $4.98 million ($4.88 million after tax), for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, in order to reflect the carrying value of goodwill and certain trademarks in our Personal Care segment at current estimates of their fair value.  With respect to all trademarks for which such impairments were recorded, we currently expect to continue to hold these trademarks for future use.

 

(j)           Economic useful lives and amortization of intangible assets

 

We amortize intangible assets, such as licenses and trademarks, over their economic useful lives, unless those assets’ economic useful lives are indefinite. If an intangible asset’s economic useful life is deemed to be indefinite, that asset is not amortized. When we acquire an intangible asset, we consider factors such as the asset’s history, our plans for that asset, and the market for products associated with the asset. We consider these same factors when reviewing the economic useful lives of our existing intangible assets as well.  We review the economic useful lives of our intangible assets at least annually.

 

Intangible assets consist primarily of goodwill, license agreements, trademarks, customer lists, distribution rights, patents, patent licenses and non-compete agreements.  All of our goodwill is held in jurisdictions that do not allow deductions for tax purposes.  We amortize certain intangible assets using the straight-line method over appropriate periods ranging from 5 to 40 years. We recorded intangible asset amortization totaling $6.13, $3.31 and $3.27 million during fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. See Notes (4) and (5) to these consolidated financial statements for more information about our intangible assets.

 

73



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

(k)       Auction rate securities

 

Prior to fiscal 2009, we made investments of excess cash on hand in AAA auction rate notes, AAA variable rate demand bonds, and similar investments that we normally seek to dispose of within 35 or fewer days (“auction rate securities” or “ARS”).  Since fiscal 2009, these ARS were subject to failed auctions that affected our ability to access the funds in the near term.  Auctions fail when there is insufficient demand.  However, this does not represent a default by the issuer of the security. Upon an auction failure, the interest rates reset based on a formula contained in the security.  The securities will continue to accrue interest and to be auctioned until one of the following occurs: the auction succeeds; the issuer calls the securities; or the securities mature.  At February 28, 2010 these securities had underlying remaining maturities from 19 to 36 years and approximately 97 percent of the aggregate collateral (student loans) guaranteed by the U.S. government under the Federal Family Education Loan Program.

 

At February 28, 2010 and 2009, we held $20.53 and $19.97 million of ARS, respectively classified as non-current assets held for sale under the heading “Other assets, net of accumulated amortization” on our consolidated balance sheets.  We classify these assets as long-term because while we intend to continue to reduce our remaining holdings as soon as practicable, we believe it unlikely that we can liquidate all of our holdings within twelve months.

 

At fiscal year-end 2010 and 2009, we had cumulative pre-tax unrealized losses on our ARS of $1.87 and $2.68 million, respectively, which are reflected in accumulated other comprehensive loss in our accompanying consolidated balance sheets, net of related tax effects of $0.64 and $0.91 million, respectively. The recording of these unrealized losses is not a result of the quality of the underlying collateral, but rather a markdown reflecting a lack of liquidity and other market conditions.  For the fiscal years ended February 28, 2010 and 2009, we liquidated $0.25 and $41.18 million, respectively, of these securities at par.

 

Notes (10) and (11) contain additional information regarding our cash, cash equivalents, trading securities and long-term investments.

 

(l)           Fair value classifications

 

We classify our various assets and liabilities recorded or reported at fair value under a hierarchy prescribed by GAAP that prioritizes inputs to fair value measurement techniques into three broad levels:

 

·                  Level 1: Observable inputs such as quoted prices for identical assets or liabilities in active markets.

 

·                  Level 2: Observable inputs other than quoted prices that are directly or indirectly observable for the asset or liability, including quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets; quoted prices for similar or identical assets or liabilities in markets that are not active; and model-derived valuations whose inputs are observable or whose significant value drivers are observable.

 

·                  Level 3: Unobservable inputs that reflect the reporting entity’s own assumptions.

 

Assets and liabilities subject to classification are classified upon acquisition.  When circumstances dictate the transfer of an asset or liability to a different level, our policy is to recognize the transfer at the beginning of the reporting period in which the event resulting in the transfer occurred.

 

(m)   Deferred financing costs

 

The Company has incurred debt issuance costs in connection with its short- and long-term debt. These costs are capitalized as deferred financing costs and amortized using the straight-line method over the term of the related debt, which approximates the effective interest method of amortization.

 

74



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

(n)       Warranties

 

Our products are under warranty against defects in material and workmanship for a maximum of two years. We estimate our warranty accrual using historical trends and believe that these trends are the most reliable method by which we can estimate our warranty liability. The following table summarizes the activity in the Company’s accrual for the past three fiscal years:

 

ACCRUAL FOR WARRANTY RETURNS

(in thousands)

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning balance

 

$

6,940

 

$

7,635

 

Additions to the accrual

 

11,241

 

16,685

 

Reductions of the accrual - payments and credits issued

 

(12,939

)

(17,380

)

Ending balance

 

$

5,242

 

$

6,940

 

 

Certain entities whose financial statements are a part of these consolidated financial statements have guaranteed obligations of other entities within the consolidated group.  Additional information regarding these guarantees, our product warranty liabilities and various indemnity arrangements to which we are a party are provided in Notes (6), (7), (8) and (12) to these consolidated financial statements.

 

(o)       Financial instruments

 

The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, receivables, accounts payable, accrued expenses and income taxes payable approximate fair value because of the short maturity of these items. See Note (8) to these consolidated financial statements for our assessment of the fair value of our guaranteed Senior Notes and other long-term debt.

 

We use interest rate swaps (the “swaps”) to protect our funding costs against rising interest rates.  The interest rate swaps allow us to raise long-term borrowings at floating rates and effectively swap them into fixed rates.  Under our swaps, we agree with another party to exchange quarterly the difference between fixed-rate and floating-rate interest amounts calculated by reference to notional amounts that match the amount of our underlying debt.  Under these swap agreements, we pay the fixed rates and receive the floating rates.  The swaps settle quarterly and terminate upon maturity of the related debt.  We hedge a portion of our foreign exchange rate risk by entering into contracts to exchange foreign currencies for U.S. Dollars at specified rates.

 

Our foreign exchange contracts and interest rate swaps are considered highly effective.  See Notes (10) and (11) to these consolidated financial statements for more information on our hedging activities.

 

(p)       Income taxes and uncertain tax positions

 

Deferred income tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences of temporary differences between the book and tax bases of applicable assets and liabilities. Generally, deferred tax assets represent future income tax reductions while deferred tax liabilities represent income taxes that we expect to pay in the future. We measure deferred tax assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates for the years in which we expect temporary differences to be reversed or be settled. Changes in tax rates affect the carrying values of our deferred tax assets and liabilities. The ultimate realization of our deferred tax assets depends upon generating sufficient future taxable income during the periods in which our temporary differences become deductible or before our net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards expire. The effects of any tax rate changes are recognized in the periods when they become effective.

 

75



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

We recognize the benefit of a tax position if that position will more likely than not be sustained in an audit, based on the technical merits of the position.  If the tax position meets the more likely than not recognition threshold, the tax effect is recognized at the largest amount of the benefit that has greater than a fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement.  Liabilities created for unrecognized tax benefits are presented as a separate liability and not combined with deferred tax liabilities or assets, and consistent with past practice, we recognize interest and penalties accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits in the provision for income taxes.  Note (9) to these consolidated financial statements contains additional information regarding our income taxes.

 

(q)       Revenue recognition

 

Sales are recognized when revenue is realized or realizable and has been earned. Sales and shipping terms vary among our customers, and as such, revenue is recognized when risk and title to the product transfer to the customer. Net sales revenue is comprised of gross revenues less estimates of expected returns, trade discounts and customer allowances, which include incentives such as cooperative advertising agreements and off-invoice markdowns. Such deductions are recorded and/or amortized during the period the related revenue is recognized. Sales and value added taxes collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are excluded from net sales revenue reported in the consolidated financial statements.

 

(r)         Consideration granted to customers

 

We offer our customers certain incentives in the form of cooperative advertising arrangements, volume rebates, product markdown allowances, trade discounts, cash discounts, slotting fees and similar other arrangements.  In instances where the customer provides us with proof of performance, reductions in amounts received from customers as a result of cooperative advertising programs are included in our consolidated statements of income in SG&A.

 

Other reductions in amounts received from customers as a result of cooperative advertising programs are recorded as reductions of net sales revenue.  Markdown allowances, slotting fees, trade discounts, cash discounts and volume rebates are all recorded as reductions of net sales revenue. Customer incentives included in SG&A were $10.40, $11.81 and $12.16 million for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

(s)        Advertising

 

Advertising costs, including cooperative advertising discussed in (r) above, are expensed in the fiscal year in which they are incurred and included in our consolidated statements of income in SG&A. We incurred total advertising costs, including amounts paid to customers for cooperative media and print advertising, of $20.77, $24.45 and $31.34 million during fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

(t)          Shipping and handling revenues and expenses

 

Shipping and handling expenses are included in our consolidated statements of income in SG&A. These expenses include distribution center costs, third party logistics costs and outbound transportation costs.  Our expenses for shipping and handling totaled $44.87, $49.68 and $51.94 million during fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. We bill our customers for charges for shipping and handling on certain sales made directly to consumers and retail customers ordering relatively small dollar amounts of product. Such charges are recorded as a reduction of our shipping and handling expense and are not material in the aggregate.

 

76



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

(u)       Foreign currency transactions and related derivative financial instruments

 

The U.S. Dollar is our functional currency.  All our non-U.S. subsidiaries’ transactions involving other currencies have been re-measured in U.S. Dollars using average exchange rates for the months in which the transactions occurred.  In our consolidated statements of income, exchange gains and losses resulting from the remeasurement of foreign taxes receivable, taxes payable, deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities are recognized in their respective income tax lines and all other foreign exchange gains and losses are recognized in SG&A. We recorded net foreign exchange gains (losses), including the impact of currency hedges, of $1.73, ($5.21) and $0.53 million in SG&A and $0.05, $0.62 and $0.22 million in income tax expense during fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

In order to manage our exposure to changes in foreign currency exchange rates, we use forward currency contracts to exchange foreign currencies for U.S. Dollars at specified rates.  We account for these transactions as hedges, which requires that these forward currency contracts be recorded on the balance sheet at their fair value and that changes in the fair value of the forward exchange contracts are recorded each period in our consolidated statements of income or other comprehensive income (loss), depending on the type of hedging instrument and the effectiveness of the hedges.  In our case, we record these transactions either as part of SG&A in our consolidated statements of income, or on the line entitled “Unrealized gain (loss) on cash flow hedges – foreign currency, net of tax” in our consolidated statements of stockholders’ equity, as appropriate.  All our current contracts are cash flow hedges and are adjusted to their fair market values at the end of each fiscal quarter.  We evaluate all hedging transactions each quarter to determine that they are effective. Any ineffectiveness is recorded as part of SG&A in our consolidated statements of income.  See Note (11) to these consolidated financial statements for a further discussion of our hedging activities.

 

(v)       Share-based compensation plans

 

All share-based payments are recognized in the financial statements based on their fair values using an option pricing model at the date of grant.  We use a Black-Scholes option-pricing model to calculate the fair value of options.  This model requires various judgmental assumptions including volatility, forfeiture rates and expected option life.  If any of the assumptions used in the model change significantly, share-based compensation may differ materially in the future from that recorded in the current period.  We estimate forfeitures for options awards at the dates of grant based on historical experience and revise as necessary if actual forfeitures significantly differ from these estimates.  Stock-based compensation expense is adjusted for estimated forfeitures and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of the award.

 

See Note (14) to these consolidated financial statements for more information on our share-based compensation plans.

 

(w)   Interest income

 

Interest income is included in “Nonoperating income (expense)” on the consolidated statements of income.  Interest income totaled $0.57, $2.72 and $3.57  million in fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Interest income is normally earned on cash invested in short-term accounts, cash equivalents, temporary and long-term investments.

 

77



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 1 - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES, CONTINUED

 

(x)       Earnings (loss) per share

 

We compute basic earnings (loss) per share based upon the weighted average number of shares of common stock outstanding during the period. We compute diluted earnings (loss) per share based upon the weighted average number of shares of common stock plus the effects of potentially dilutive securities. Our dilutive securities consist entirely of outstanding options for common stock that were “in-the-money,” meaning that the exercise price of the options was less than the average market price of our common stock during the fiscal year.  “Out-of-the-money” options are outstanding options to purchase common stock that were excluded from the computation of earnings per share because the exercise price of the options was greater than the average market price of our common stock during the fiscal year.  Options for common stock are excluded from the computation of diluted earnings (loss) per share if their effect is antidilutive.

 

For fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, the components of basic and diluted shares were as follows:

 

WEIGHTED AVERAGE DILUTED SECURITIES

(in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended The Last Day of February,

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, basic

 

30,217

 

30,173

 

30,531

 

Incremental shares of common stock attributable to share-based payment arrangements (1)

 

704

 

-    

 

1,267

 

Weighted average shares outstanding, diluted

 

30,921

 

30,173

 

31,798

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dilutive securities, as a result of in-the-money options

 

1,978

 

2,587

 

3,914

 

Antidilutive securities, as a result of out-of-the-money options

 

921

 

2,249

 

1,922

 

 

(1)       Fiscal 2009 earnings per share computations excludes conversion of in-the-money stock options as the effect of the 846,000 shares would be antidilutive.

 

(y)       New accounting pronouncements

 

From time to time, new accounting pronouncements are issued by the FASB or other standards setting bodies that are adopted by the Company as of the specified effective date.  Unless otherwise discussed, the Company’s management believes that the impact of recently issued standards that are not yet effective will not have a material impact on its consolidated financial position, results of operations and cash flows upon adoption.

 

NOTE 2 – SIGNIFICANT CHARGE AGAINST ALLOWANCE FOR DOUBTFUL ACCOUNTS

 

On May 2, 2008, Linens ‘n Things retail chain (“Linens”), filed for protection under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. Our accounts receivable balance with Linens at the date of bankruptcy was $4.17 million.  For the fiscal quarter ended May 31, 2008, a bad debt provision charge of $3.88 million was made to SG&A and we established a specific allowance of the same amount to account for the portion of the receivable we estimated to be uncollectible.  For the fiscal quarter ended August 31, 2008, we charged the remaining $0.29 million unreserved balance of Linens’ pre-petition accounts receivables to our bad debt provision and wrote off the resulting 100 percent reserved balance as uncollectable.  During the fiscal quarter ended November 30, 2008, Linens announced plans to liquidate by December 31, 2008.  There were no further sales to Linens and we have fully collected all post-petition receivables as of the quarter ended November 30, 2008.  Linens was a significant customer of the Company with net sales revenue for fiscal 2009 of $0.55 million and $7.24 million for the Personal Care and Housewares segments, respectively, compared to net sales revenue of $1.30 million and $17.30 million in the same segments, respectively, for fiscal 2008.

 

78


 


Table of Contents

 

NOTE 3 - PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

 

A summary of property and equipment is as follows:

 

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

(in thousands)

 

 

Estimated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Useful Lives

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

(Years)

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Land

 

-

 

$

9,073

 

$

9,073

 

Buildings and improvements

 

10 - 40

 

65,117

 

65,028

 

Computer and other equipment

 

3 - 10

 

46,088

 

43,144

 

Tools, Dies and Molds

 

1 - 3

 

9,573

 

8,880

 

Transportation equipment

 

3 - 5

 

240

 

340

 

Furniture and fixtures

 

5 - 15

 

8,532

 

8,385

 

Construction in progress

 

-

 

1,954

 

703

 

Property and equipment, gross

 

 

 

140,577

 

135,553

 

Less accumulated depreciation

 

 

 

(58,464

)

(51,607

)

Property and equipment, net

 

 

 

$

82,113

 

$

83,946

 

 

On September 9, 2007, we sold 16.5 acres of raw land adjacent to our El Paso, Texas office and distribution center.  The land was sold for $6.00 million, less selling costs of $0.39 million and resulted in a pre-tax gain on the sale of $3.61 million.

 

On December 20, 2007, we acquired 30.6 acres of raw land adjacent to our Southaven, Mississippi distribution center for a purchase price of $1.53 million.

 

In two separate transactions during fiscal 2009, we sold all fractional shares in our corporate jets for a combined $2.57 million and recognized a combined pre-tax gain of $0.11 million.

 

We recorded $8.80, $10.29 and $10.40 million of depreciation expense for fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Capital expenditures for property and equipment totaled $7.20, $5.17 and $7.30 million in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

We lease certain facilities, equipment and vehicles under operating leases, which expire at various dates through fiscal 2019.  Certain of the leases contain escalation clauses and renewal or purchase options.  Rent expense related to our operating leases was $2.31, $2.25 and $2.68 million for fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

NOTE 4 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

We do not record amortization expense on goodwill or other intangible assets that have indefinite useful lives. Amortization expense is recorded for intangible assets with definite useful lives. We perform an annual impairment review of goodwill and other intangible assets during the first quarter of each fiscal year. We also perform interim testing, if necessary, as required by GAAP.  Any asset deemed to be impaired is written down to its fair value.

 

The Company’s traditional impairment test methodology previously used primarily estimated future discounted cash flow Models (“DCF Models”).  The DCF Models use a number of assumptions including expected future cash flows from the assets, volatility, risk free rate, and the expected life of the assets, the determination of which require significant judgments from management.  In determining the assumptions to be used, the Company considers the existing rates on Treasury Bills, yield spreads on assets with comparable expected lives, historical volatility of the Company’s common stock and that of comparable companies and general economic and industry trends, among other considerations.  Beginning in

 

79



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 4 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS, CONTINUED

 

the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company expanded its traditional impairment test methodology to give weight to other methods that provide additional observable market information and which management believes reflect the current risk level being incorporated into market prices, in order to corroborate the fair values of each of the Company’s reporting units. The additional methods include the Subject Company Stock Price Method, the Guideline Public Company Method, and the Mergers and Acquisitions Method (together, the “Market Models”). The Subject Company Stock Price Method uses the same revenue and earnings valuation multiples embedded in the Company’s common stock price, including an appropriate control premium, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.   The Guideline Public Company Method uses a composite of revenue and earnings multiples derived as of the valuation date from a group of publicly traded companies that are in similar lines of business and serving similar distribution channels as a basis for estimating the separate values, including appropriate control premiums for each of the Company’s reporting units.  The Mergers and Acquisitions Method uses the revenue and earnings multiples embedded in a group of representative business acquisition transactions, to the extent that comparable transactions are available, as a basis for estimating the separate values of each of the Company’s reporting units.  For each of the methods used, considerable management judgment is necessary in reaching a conclusion regarding the reasonableness of fair value estimates, evaluating the most likely impact of a range of possible external conditions, considering the resulting operating changes and their impact on estimated future cash flows,  determining the appropriate discount factors to use, and selecting and weighting appropriate comparable market level inputs.

 

Impairments in the Second Quarter of Fiscal 2010 - During the fiscal quarter ended August 31, 2009, a significant customer decided to discontinue carrying our Skin Milk® brand of skin care products.   Sales to this customer accounted for a substantial portion of the total net sales revenue of this brand, and accordingly, non-cash impairment charges were recorded to write off the remaining $0.90 million ($0.89 million after tax) in carrying value of the associated trademark.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2010 - The Company performed its annual evaluation of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment during the first quarter of fiscal 2010.  The Company believes that macroeconomic factors, specifically the decline in consumer demand and consumer confidence, did not deteriorate meaningfully during the first quarter of fiscal 2010, when compared to the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  Macroeconomic factors and market conditions, namely the sustained decline of the Company’s total market capitalization below the Company’s consolidated equity late in the third quarter of fiscal 2009 through the first half of the first quarter of fiscal 2010, were originally contributing factors to our determination that interim testing was necessary in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  However, the Company’s latest projected sales and operating income for its reporting units available at the end of the first quarter of fiscal 2010 did not vary significantly relative to previous estimates determined in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 and certain values used in our impairment testing methodology were based on market prices which had improved over the quarter.  Also, the Company’s common share price recovered from the declines it experienced at the end of fiscal 2009.  These reasons, when considered together, caused us to conclude that further impairments had not occurred and extensive testing was not required for the quarter ended May 31, 2009.

 

Additional Impairment Testing in the Fourth Quarter of Fiscal 2009 - As a result of the continued deterioration of economic conditions during the second half of fiscal 2009, the Company evaluated the impact of these conditions and other developments on its reporting units to assess whether impairment indicators were present that would require interim impairment testing. During the latter half of the third quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company’s total market capitalization began to decline below the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity balance at November 30, 2008.  If the Company’s total market capitalization remains below its consolidated stockholders’ equity balance for a sustained period of time, this may be an indicator of potential impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets.  Because this condition continued throughout the balance of the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company determined that the carrying amount of our goodwill and other intangible assets might not be recoverable and performed additional impairment testing as of February 28, 2009.

 

80



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 4 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS, CONTINUED

 

The impairment testing for the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 was performed using an updated outlook for the Company’s reporting units completed in connection with its annual planning process.  This outlook included downward adjustments to certain future expected revenues and increases in the market participant discount rates, when compared to the projections and discount rates upon which our annual impairment tests were prepared during the first fiscal quarter of 2009.  The Company decreased its expected revenues in response to the reduction in consumer spending during the second half of fiscal 2009 and its expectation that depressed spending levels would persist into fiscal 2010.  Additionally, the Company increased the market participant discount rates used in its analysis because management believes that the lending market and the restrained liquidity in the current environment have increased the cost of capital.  In determining the extent to which to change its assumptions, management considered consumer spending trends and the anticipated impact on each reporting unit as well as the market cost of capital for comparable companies for each reporting unit. This resulted in a total non-cash impairment charge of $99.51 million ($99.06 million after tax) in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  This consisted of non-cash pre-tax impairment charges of $46.49 million against goodwill and $2.75 million against a trademark in our Personal Care segment’s Appliances and Accessories reporting unit and $50.27 million against certain trademarks and an indefinite-lived license held by our Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions reporting unit.  The impairment for these reporting units was due to a decrease in the fair value of forecasted cash flows, and other market conditions reflecting the continued deterioration of the domestic and global economies and the declines in retail sales activity.  No impairment charges were required for our Housewares segment as this reporting unit’s estimated fair value of total net assets including recorded goodwill, trademarks and other intangible assets, exceeded their carrying values as of the date of the evaluation.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2009 - The Company performed its annual impairment tests of its goodwill and trademarks during the first quarter of fiscal 2009.  This resulted in non-cash impairment charges of $7.76 million ($7.61 million after tax) on certain intangible assets associated with our Personal Care segment recognized during the first quarter of fiscal 2009.  The charges were recorded in the Company’s consolidated statement of income as a component of operating income (loss).  The impairment charges reflected the amounts by which the carrying values of the associated assets exceeded their estimated fair values at the time of the analysis.  The fair values of the assets were primarily determined using DCF Models.   The decline in the fair value of the affected trademarks described above resulted from lower sales expectations on certain lower volume brands as a result of management’s strategic decision to reduce advertising and other resources dedicated to those brands, combined with a lower overall expectation of net sales revenue driven by our near-term outlook for the economy and projected declines in consumer retail spending levels.

 

Impairments in the Third Quarter of Fiscal 2008 - In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, we re-introduced the newly formulated Epil-Stop® product line.  During the second and third quarters of fiscal 2008, our Epil-Stop® brand of hair depilatory products lost placement in certain mass discount and drug channels due to low consumer response.  We experienced a high rate of customer sales returns for the product line.  In response to these circumstances, in the third quarter of fiscal 2008, we conducted a strategic review of the Epil-Stop® trademark. We also evaluated the future potential of our TimeBlock® brand in light of our recent experience with Epil-Stop®.  From these reviews, we concluded that the future undiscounted cash flows associated with these trademarks were insufficient to recover their carrying values.  We also believed that any significant additional investments in these brands would not generate potential returns in line with the Company’s investment expectations.  Accordingly, we recorded pre-tax impairment charges totaling $4.98 million ($4.88 million after tax) representing the carrying value of these trademarks.  We continue to hold these trademarks for use.

 

Annual Impairment Testing in the First Quarter of Fiscal 2008 - The Company performed its annual impairment tests of its goodwill and trademarks during the first quarter of fiscal 2008. No impairment charge was recorded during the first quarter of fiscal 2008 as the estimated fair value of the indefinite-lived trademarks and licenses, reporting unit net assets, and the Company’s estimated enterprise value exceeded their respective carrying values as of the date of the evaluation.

 

81



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 4 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS, CONTINUED

 

The following tables summarize by operating segment the changes in our goodwill and intangible assets for fiscal years 2010 and 2009:

 

GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

February 28, 2009

 

 

Year Ended February 28, 2010

 

 

February 28, 2010

 

 

 

Average

 

Gross

 

Cumulative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Life

 

Carrying

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

 

 

Acquisition

 

Accumulated

 

Net Book

 

Description / Life

 

(Years)

 

Amount

 

Impairments

 

Additions

 

Impairments

 

Adjustments

 

Amortization

 

Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

$

46,490

 

$

(46,490

)

$

19,700

 

$

-    

 

$

106

 

$

-    

 

$

19,806

 

Trademarks - indefinite

 

 

 

35,575

 

-    

 

18,700

 

(900

)

(321

)

-    

 

53,054

 

Trademarks - finite

 

18.6

 

338

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(245

)

93

 

Licenses - indefinite

 

 

 

10,300

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

10,300

 

Licenses - finite

 

9.7

 

24,196

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(19,495

)

4,701

 

Other Intangibles - finite

 

7.4

 

4,689

 

-    

 

21,600

 

-    

 

(3

)

(4,049

)

22,237

 

Total Personal Care

 

 

 

121,588

 

(46,490

)

60,000

 

(900

)

(218

)

(23,789

)

110,191

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Housewares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

166,131

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

166,131

 

Trademarks - indefinite

 

 

 

75,554

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

75,554

 

Other Intangibles - finite

 

6.6

 

20,329

 

-    

 

516

 

-    

 

-    

 

(9,660

)

11,185

 

Total Housewares

 

 

 

262,014

 

-    

 

516

 

-    

 

-    

 

(9,660

)

252,870

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

$

383,602

 

$

(46,490

)

$

60,516

 

$

(900

)

$

(218

)

$

(33,449

)

$

363,061

 

 

GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

February 29, 2008

 

 

Year Ended February 28, 2009

 

 

February 28, 2009

 

 

 

Average

 

Gross

 

Cumulative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Life

 

Carrying

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

 

 

Acquisition

 

Accumulated

 

Net Book

 

Description / Life

 

(Years)

 

Amount

 

Impairments

 

Additions

 

Impairments

 

Adjustments

 

Amortization

 

Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Care:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

$

46,791

 

$

-     

 

$

-    

 

$

(46,490

)

$

(301

)

$

-    

 

$

-    

 

Trademarks - indefinite

 

 

 

86,265

 

-     

 

2,275

 

(52,965

)

 

 

-    

 

35,575

 

Trademarks - finite

 

19.6

 

338

 

-     

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

(240

)

98

 

Licenses - indefinite

 

 

 

18,000

 

-     

 

-    

 

(7,700

)

-    

 

-    

 

10,300

 

Licenses - finite

 

8.8

 

24,315

 

-     

 

-    

 

(119

)

-    

 

(18,479

)

5,717

 

Other Intangibles - finite

 

5.8

 

2,235

 

-     

 

2,454

 

-    

 

-    

 

(975

)

3,714

 

Total Personal Care

 

 

 

177,944

 

-     

 

4,729

 

(107,274

)

(301

)

(19,694

)

55,404

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Housewares:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

166,131

 

-     

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

166,131

 

Trademarks - indefinite

 

 

 

75,554

 

-     

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

75,554

 

Other Intangibles - finite

 

7.6

 

19,741

 

-     

 

588

 

-    

 

-    

 

(7,627

)

12,702

 

Total Housewares

 

 

 

261,426

 

-     

 

588

 

-    

 

-    

 

(7,627

)

254,387

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

$

439,370

 

$

-     

 

$

5,317

 

$

(107,274

)

$

(301

)

$

(27,321

)

$

309,791

 

 

82



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 4 – GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS, CONTINUED

 

The following table summarizes the amortization expense attributable to intangible assets for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, as well as estimated amortization expense for the fiscal years 2011 through 2015:

 

AMORTIZATION OF INTANGIBLE ASSETS

(in thousands)

Aggregate Amortization Expense

 

 

 

For the fiscal years ended

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

February 2010

 

$

6,128

 

February 2009

 

$

3,311

 

February 2008

 

$

3,266

 

 

 

 

 

Estimated Amortization Expense

 

 

 

For the fiscal years ended

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

February 2011

 

$

5,233

 

February 2012

 

$

5,120

 

February 2013

 

$

5,087

 

February 2014

 

$

4,622

 

February 2015

 

$

4,545

 

 

Many of the license agreements under which we sell or intend to sell products with trademarks owned by other entities require that we pay minimum royalties and make minimum levels of advertising expenditures.  For the fiscal year ending February 28, 2011, minimum royalties due and minimum advertising expenditures under these license agreements total $6.44 and $6.03 million, respectively.

 

NOTE 5 – ACQUISITIONS

 

Infusium 23® Acquisition - On March 31, 2009, we completed the acquisition of certain assets, trademarks, customer lists, distribution rights, patents, goodwill and formulas for Infusium 23® (“Infusium”) hair care products from The Procter & Gamble Company for a cash purchase price of $60 million, which we paid with cash on hand.  We have accounted for the acquisition as the purchase of a business, and have recorded the excess purchase price as goodwill. All of this goodwill is held in jurisdictions that do not allow deductions for tax purposes. We have completed our analysis of the economic lives of all the assets acquired and determined the appropriate allocation of the initial purchase price. We assigned the acquired trademarks indefinite economic lives and will amortize the customer list and patent rights over expected lives of 9.0 and 7.5 years, respectively.  For the customer list, we used our historical attrition rates to assign an expected life.  For patent rights, we used the underlying non-renewable term of a royalty free license we acquired for the use of patented formulas in certain Infusium products. The trademarks acquired are considered to have indefinite lives that are not subject to amortization.  The goodwill arising from the Infusium acquisition consists largely of the distribution network, marketing synergies, and economies of scale expected to occur from the addition of the new product line. The following schedule presents the acquisition date fair value of the net assets of Infusium:

 

Infusium - Assets Acquired on March 31, 2009

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 Goodwill

 

$

19,700

 

 Trademarks

 

18,700

 

 Patent rights

 

600

 

 Customer list

 

21,000

 

Total assets acquired

 

$

60,000

 

 

83



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 5 – ACQUISITIONS, CONTINUED

 

The fair values of the Infusium assets acquired were estimated by applying income and market approaches. These fair value measurements are based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market and, therefore, represent Level 3 measurements as defined under GAAP. Key assumptions include (1) a discount rate of 13.5 percent, (2) a terminal value based on long-term sustainable growth rates of 2 percent and an earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, and amortization (“EBITDA”) multiple of 7.0, (3) financial multiples of companies operating in similar markets as Infusium, and (4) adjustments for control premiums that market participants might consider when estimating the fair value of the Infusium business.  In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2010, we made certain post closing adjustments associated with this acquisition to increase goodwill by $0.10 million.

 

Ogilvie® Products Acquisition - On October 10, 2008, we acquired from Ascendia Brands, Inc. the trademarks, customer lists, distribution rights, formulas and inventory of the Ogilvie® (“Ogilvie”) brand of home permanent and hair-straightening products for a cash purchase price of $4.77 million.  In addition, upon acquisition, we recorded an additional $0.35 million of liabilities that we expect we will incur as a result of pre-acquisition operations. The products acquired will be sold through our Personal Care segment.  We completed an analysis of the economic lives of all the assets acquired and determined the appropriate allocation of the initial purchase price based upon the fair value of the assets acquired.  Based upon the fair values, we assigned the acquired trademarks indefinite economic lives and will amortize the distribution rights over an expected life of 15 years and the customer list over an expected life of 4.2 years.  The following schedule presents the assets acquired at closing and our allocation of the initial purchase price:

 

Ogilvie - Net Assets Acquired on October 10, 2008

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

Inventories

 

$

521

 

Trademarks

 

2,275

 

Distribution rights

 

761

 

Customer list

 

1,560

 

Total assets acquired

 

5,117

 

Less: Current liabilities recorded at acquisition

 

(352

)

Net assets acquired

 

$

4,765

 

 

See Note (20) for additional information regarding the acquisition of the Pert Plus® (“Pert Plus”) hair care and Sure® (“Sure”) anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC subsequent to February 28, 2010.

 

84


 


Table of Contents

 

NOTE 6 – SHORT-TERM DEBT

 

We have a Revolving Line of Credit Agreement (the “RCA”) with Bank of America, N.A. that provides for a total revolving commitment of up to $50 million, subject to certain limitations as discussed below. The commitment under the RCA terminates on December 15, 2013.  Borrowings under the RCA accrue interest at a “Base Rate” plus a margin of 0.25 to 0.75 percent based on the “Leverage Ratio” at the time of borrowing.  The base rate is equal to the highest of the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.50 percent, Bank of America’s prime rate, or the one month LIBOR rate plus 1 percent.  Alternatively, upon our timely election, borrowings accrue interest based on the respective 1, 2, 3, or 6-month LIBOR rate plus a margin of 1.25 percent to 1.75 percent based upon the “Leverage Ratio” (as defined in the RCA) at the time of the borrowing. We incur loan commitment fees at a current rate of 0.20 percent per annum on the unused balance of the RCA and letter of credit fees at a current rate of 1.25 percent per annum on the face value of any letter of credit. Outstanding letters of credit reduce the borrowing availability dollar for dollar.  As of February 28, 2010, there were no revolving loans and $0.20 million of open letters of credit outstanding against this facility.

 

The RCA contains certain covenants and formulas that limit our outstanding indebtedness from all sources (less unrestricted cash on hand in excess of $15 million) to no more than 3.0 times the latest twelve months’ trailing EBITDA. As of February 28, 2010, our loan covenants effectively limited our ability to incur more than $288.42 million of additional debt from all sources, including draws on our RCA.  The RCA is guaranteed, on a joint and several basis, by our parent company, Helen of Troy Limited, and certain subsidiaries.  Additionally, our debt agreements restrict us from incurring liens on any of our properties, except under certain conditions, and limit our ability to repurchase shares of our common stock.  As of February 28, 2010, we were in compliance with the terms of the RCA and our other debt agreements.

 

NOTE 7 – ACCRUED EXPENSES AND OTHER CURRENT LIABILITIES

 

A summary of accrued expenses and other current liabilities is as follows:

 

ACCRUED EXPENSES AND OTHER CURRENT LIABILITIES

(in thousands)

 

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued sales returns, discounts and allowances

 

$

20,758

 

$

21,235

 

Accrued compensation

 

17,888

 

4,487

 

Accrued advertising

 

6,862

 

5,606

 

Accrued interest

 

1,339

 

2,140

 

Accrued royalties

 

3,612

 

3,513

 

Accrued professional fees

 

730

 

1,053

 

Accrued benefits and payroll taxes

 

1,170

 

1,455

 

Accrued freight

 

1,398

 

912

 

Accrued property, sales and other taxes

 

879

 

660

 

Interest rate swaps, current portion

 

4,951

 

4,853

 

Other

 

7,702

 

6,183

 

Total accrued expenses and other current liabilities

 

$

67,289

 

$

52,097

 

 

85



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 8 - LONG-TERM DEBT

 

A summary of long-term debt is as follows:

 

LONG-TERM DEBT

(dollars in thousands)

 

 

Original

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date

 

Interest

 

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

Borrowed

 

Rates

 

Matures

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$15 million unsecured Senior Note payable at a fixed interest rate of 7.24%. Interest payable quarterly. Annual principal payments of $3 million began in July 2008.

 

07/97

 

7.24%

 

07/12

 

$

9,000

 

$

12,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$75 million unsecured floating interest rate 5 year Senior Notes. Interest set and payable quarterly at three-month LIBOR plus 85 basis points. Principal was due and paid on June 29, 2009.

 

06/04

 

5.89%

 

06/09

 

-    

 

75,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$50 million unsecured floating interest rate 7 year Senior Notes. Interest set and payable quarterly at three-month LIBOR plus 85 basis points. Principal is due at maturity. Notes can be prepaid without penalty. (1)

 

06/04

 

5.89%

 

06/11

 

50,000

 

50,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$75 million unsecured floating interest rate 10 year Senior Notes. Interest set and payable quarterly at three-month LIBOR plus 90 basis points. Principal is due at maturity. Notes can be prepaid without penalty. (1)

 

06/04

 

6.01%

 

06/14

 

75,000

 

75,000

 

Total long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

134,000

 

212,000

 

Less current maturities of long-term debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3,000

)

(78,000

)

Long-term debt, excluding current maturities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

131,000

 

$

134,000

 

 

(1)  Floating interest rates have been hedged with interest rate swaps to effectively fix interest rates.  Additional information regarding these swaps is provided in Note (11) to these consolidated financial statements.

 

The fair market value of the fixed rate debt at February 28, 2010 computed using a discounted cash flow analysis was $9.60 million compared to the $9 million book value.  All other long-term debt has floating interest rates, and its book value approximates its fair value at February 28, 2010.

 

All of our long-term debt is unconditionally guaranteed by our parent company, Helen of Troy Limited, and/or certain subsidiaries on a joint and several basis.  Our debt agreements require the maintenance of certain debt/EBITDA and interest coverage ratios, specify minimum consolidated net worth levels and contain other customary covenants. As of February 28, 2010, our debt agreements effectively limited our ability to incur more than $288.42 million of additional debt from all sources, including draws on our RCA.  Additionally, our debt agreements restrict us from incurring liens on any of our properties, except under certain conditions, and limit our ability to repurchase shares of our common stock.  As of February 28, 2010, we were in compliance with the terms of these agreements.

 

86



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 8 - LONG-TERM DEBT, CONTINUED

 

The following table contains a summary of the components of our interest expense for the periods covered by our consolidated statements of income:

 

INTEREST EXPENSE

(in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended The Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest and commitment fees

 

$

3,468

 

$

8,888

 

$

14,633

 

Deferred finance costs

 

332

 

582

 

628

 

Interest rate swap settlements, net

 

6,510

 

4,217

 

(355

)

Reduction of debt and revolving credit agreement commitment

 

-    

 

-    

 

119

 

Total interest expense

 

$

10,310

 

$

13,687

 

$

15,025

 

 

The line entitled “Reduction of debt and revolving credit agreement commitment” includes the fiscal 2008 write off of $0.28 million of unamortized deferred finance fees incurred in connection with the prepayment of long-term debt and the reduction of the commitments under our RCA, offset by a gain of $0.16 million upon the liquidation of our position in $25 million of associated interest rate swaps.

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES

 

Our components of income (loss) before income tax expense are as follows:

 

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February,

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S.

 

$

14,529

 

$

(15,267

)

$

17,986

 

Non-U.S.

 

65,576

 

(36,198

)

43,287

 

Total

 

$

80,105

 

$

(51,465

)

$

61,273

 

 

Our components of income tax expense (benefit) are as follows:

 

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February,

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

$

3,924

 

$

964

 

$

6,459

 

Deferred

 

2,637

 

2,140

 

(619

)

 

 

6,561

 

3,104

 

5,840

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-U.S.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current

 

963

 

1,891

 

(6,026

)

Deferred

 

764

 

333

 

(50

)

 

 

1,727

 

2,224

 

(6,076

)

Total

 

$

8,288

 

$

5,328

 

$

(236

)

 

87



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES, CONTINUED

 

Our total income tax expense differs from the amounts computed by applying the statutory tax rate to income (loss) before income taxes. A summary of these differences are as follows:

 

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expected effective income tax rate at the U.S. statutory rate of 35 percent

 

35.0%

 

-35.0%

 

35.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impact of U.S. state income taxes

 

1.8%

 

1.4%

 

1.5%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Decrease in income taxes resulting from income from non-U.S. operations subject to varying income tax rates

 

-9.8%

 

-15.1%

 

-7.9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Effect of zero tax rate in Macau

 

-17.1%

 

-11.8%

 

-13.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reversal of prior accruals as a result of final tax audit settlements

 

0.0%

 

-0.9%

 

-15.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Effect of asset impairment charges, most of which are non-deductible

 

0.4%

 

71.8%

 

-      

 

Effective income tax rate

 

10.3%

 

10.4%

 

-0.4%

 

 

In addition to certain of the items noted in the previous table, each year there are significant transactions or events that are incidental to our core businesses and that by a combination of their nature and jurisdiction, can have a disproportionate impact on our reported effective tax rates.  Without these transactions or events, the trend in our effective tax rates would follow a more normalized pattern.

 

The following table shows the comparative impact of these items on our pre-tax income (loss), tax expense (benefit) and effective tax rates, for each of the years covered by this report:

 

IMPACT OF SIGNIFICANT ITEMS ON PRETAX INCOME (LOSS), TAX EXPENSE (BENEFIT) AND EFFECTIVE TAX RATES

(dollars in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February

 

 

 

2010 - Increase (Decrease)

 

2009 - Increase (Decrease)

 

2008 - Increase (Decrease)

 

 

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

Pre-tax

 

Tax

 

Effective

 

 

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

Income

 

Expense

 

Tax Rates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tax benefit from HK IRD Settlement, including interest income and reversal of penalties

 

$

-      

 

$

-    

 

-       

 

$

-    

 

$

-    

 

-     

 

$

-    

 

$

(7,950

)

-12.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tax benefit from IRS settlement, including interest and penalties

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

-    

 

(461

)

-0.9%

 

-    

 

(1,363

)

-2.2%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net operating loss valuation allowance

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

-    

 

-    

 

-     

 

 

 

977

 

1.6%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

(107,274

)

(608

)

26.9%

 

(4,983

)

(100

)

-0.2%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gain on sale of land

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

-    

 

-    

 

-     

 

3,609

 

1,364

 

2.2%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gains on litigation settlements

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

-    

 

-    

 

-     

 

104

 

2

 

0.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charge to allowance for doubtful accounts due to customer bankruptcy

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

(3,876

)

(1,360

)

-1.6%

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gains on casualty insurance settlements

 

-      

 

-    

 

-       

 

2,702

 

67

 

-0.5%

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

 

There were no significant items impacting our effective tax rates in fiscal 2010.  The combined net effect of the significant items shown above was to increase our effective tax rate by 23.9 percent in fiscal 2009, and decrease our effective tax rate by 11.3 percent in fiscal 2008.

 

88



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES, CONTINUED

 

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets and liabilities as of the last day of February 2010 and 2009 are as follows:

 

 

 

Last Day of February,

 

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets, gross:

 

 

 

 

 

Operating loss carryforwards

 

$

4,569

 

$

4,599

 

Accounts receivable

 

1,134

 

517

 

Inventories, principally due to additional cost of inventories for tax purposes

 

5,980

 

8,934

 

Write down of marketable securities

 

14

 

10

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

5,554

 

5,327

 

Foreign currency contracts, interest rate swaps, and deferred exchange gains

 

3,326

 

5,378

 

Total gross deferred tax assets

 

20,577

 

24,765

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Valuation allowance

 

(4,909

)

(4,458

)

Deferred tax liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

(5,344

)

(5,679

)

Total deferred tax assets, net

 

$

10,324

 

$

14,628

 

 

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, we consider whether it is more likely than not that some portion of all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.  The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible.  We consider the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, expected future taxable income and tax planning strategies in making this assessment.  In fiscal 2010, the net increase in our valuation allowance was $0.45 million, principally due to additional net operating loss carryforwards in certain tax jurisdictions whose benefits we believe we will not be able to utilize.

 

The schedule below shows the composition of our net operating loss carryforwards and the approximate future taxable income we will need to generate in order to utilize all carryforwards prior to their expiration.

 

 

 

At February 28, 2010

 

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

Expiration

 

Gross

 

Required

 

 

 

Date Range

 

Deferred Tax

 

Future Taxable

 

 

 

(Where Applicable)

 

Assets

 

Income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. operating loss carryforwards

 

2020 - 2030

 

$

290

 

$

829

 

Non-U.S. operating loss carryforwards with indefinite carryover periods

 

Indefinite

 

4,279

 

13,869

 

Subtotals

 

 

 

4,569

 

14,698

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less portion of valuation allowance established for operating loss carryforwards

 

 

 

(4,344

)

(14,043

)

Total

 

 

 

$

225

 

$

655

 

 

As of February 28, 2010, subject to the valuation allowances provided, we believe it is more likely than not that we will realize the benefits of these deductible differences.  Any future amount of deferred tax assets considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during any carryforward periods are reduced.

 

89



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES, CONTINUED

 

Hong Kong Income Taxes – On August 24, 2007, the IRD and the Company reached a settlement regarding tax liabilities for fiscal years 1998 through 2003.  Concurrent with these settlement negotiations, we reached an agreement regarding fiscal years 2004 and 2005, for which we had not previously been assessed a tax liability. The amounts due related to the tax settlement for years 1998 through 2003, and the agreement for years 2004 and 2005, were settled with previously acquired tax reserve certificates. We received a cash refund, including interest, of $4.54 million.  During the second quarter of fiscal 2008, in connection with the settlement, we:

 

·                  reversed $5.41 million representing a portion of the tax provision previously established for those years and recorded $0.20 million of interest income related to tax reserve certificates in excess of the settlement amount; and

 

·                  reversed $1.94 million of a tax provision and $0.40 million of estimated penalties established for this jurisdiction for future years ending after fiscal 2005, on the basis of the settlement for previous years.

 

Effective March 2005, we had concluded the conduct of all operating activities in Hong Kong that we believe were the basis of the IRD’s assessments.  The Company established a Macao offshore company (“MOC”) and began similar activities in Macao and China in the third quarter of fiscal 2005.  As a MOC, we have been granted an indefinite tax holiday and pay no taxes.

 

United States Income Taxes - We previously disclosed that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) provided notice of proposed adjustments of $5.95 million to taxes for fiscal years 2003 and 2004.  In April 2008, we resolved all outstanding tax issues, which resulted in no adjustments to either year.  As a result of the settlement, in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, we reversed $3.68 million of tax provisions, including interest and penalties, previously established for those years. Of the $3.68 million, $1.36 million was credited to fiscal year 2008 tax expense and $2.32 million was credited to additional paid-in-capital.  The amount credited to additional paid-in-capital was for the tax effects of prior year common share-based compensation expense that was deemed to be deductible under the audit, and when originally accrued, was charged against additional paid-in-capital.

 

During fiscal 2009, the IRS completed its audit of our U.S. consolidated federal tax return for fiscal year 2005.  As a result of its audit, the IRS proposed adjustments totaling $8.63 million to taxes.  In December 2008, the Company and the IRS reached a settlement agreement.  As a result of the settlement, we agreed to adjustments totaling $0.49 million to fiscal 2005 taxes and interest and reversed $5.20 million of tax provisions, including interest and penalties previously established for fiscal 2005 and other years on the basis of the terms of the settlement.  Of the $5.20 million, $0.57 million was credited to fiscal year 2009 tax expense and $4.63 million was credited to additional paid-in-capital.  The amount credited to additional paid-in-capital was for the tax effects of prior year stock compensation expense that was deemed to be deductible under the audit, and when originally accrued, was charged against additional paid-in-capital.

 

Income Tax Provisions - We must make certain estimates and judgments in determining income tax expense for financial statement purposes. These estimates and judgments must be used in the calculation of certain tax assets and liabilities because of differences in the timing of recognition of revenue and expense for tax and financial statement purposes.  We must assess the likelihood that we will be able to recover our deferred tax assets.  If recovery is not likely, we must increase our provision for taxes by recording a valuation allowance against the deferred tax assets that we estimate will not ultimately be recoverable. As changes occur in our assessments regarding our ability to recover our deferred tax assets, our tax provision is increased in any period in which we determine that the recovery is not probable.

 

In 1994, we engaged in a corporate restructuring that, among other things, resulted in a greater portion of our income not being subject to taxation in the U.S.  If such income were subject to U.S. federal income taxes, our effective income tax rate would increase materially. Future actions by taxing authorities may result in tax liabilities that are significantly higher than the reserves established, which could have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations or cash flows.  Additionally, the U.S. government is currently considering several alternative proposed changes in the tax law that, if enacted, could increase our effective overall tax rate.

 

90


 

 


Table of Contents

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES, CONTINUED

 

Uncertainty in Income Taxes – The calculation of our tax liabilities involves dealing with uncertainties in the application of complex tax regulations. We recognize liabilities for anticipated tax audit issues in the U.S. and other tax jurisdictions based on our estimate of whether, and the extent to which, additional taxes will be due.  If we ultimately determine that payment of these amounts is not probable, we reverse the liability and recognize a tax benefit during the period in which we determine that the liability is no longer probable. We record an additional charge in our provision for taxes in the period in which we determine that the recorded tax liability is less than we expect the ultimate assessment to be.

 

Effective March 1, 2007, we adopted certain provisions of ASC Topic 740, “Income Taxes” (previously reported as FASB Interpretation No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109”).  As a result of this change, we recognize the benefit of a tax position if that position will more likely than not be sustained upon examination, based on the technical merits of the position.  If the tax position meets the more likely than not recognition threshold, the tax effect is recognized at the largest amount of the benefit that has greater than a fifty percent likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement.  Liabilities created for unrecognized tax benefits are presented as a separate liability and not combined with deferred tax liabilities or assets, and consistent with past practice, we recognize interest and penalties accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits in the provision for income taxes.

 

Upon adopting certain provisions of ASC Topic 740, we initially recorded a $12.06 million increase in the liability for unrecognized tax benefits (including interest and penalties), and corresponding reductions to retained earnings and additional paid-in-capital in the amounts of $5.91 and $6.14 million, respectively.  Amounts charged against additional paid-in-capital were due to the tax effect of stock compensation expense that were originally recorded as an increase to paid-in-capital.  At adoption, we had approximately $39.39 million of total gross unrecognized tax benefits, of which approximately $32.91 million would impact the effective tax rate, if recognized.  Included in our total gross unrecognized tax benefits we had approximately $4.78 million accrued for penalties and $0.31 million accrued for interest, net of tax benefits.

 

During fiscal 2010 and 2009, changes in the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits were as follows:

 

UNRECOGNIZED TAX BENEFITS

 

 

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrecognized tax benefits, beginning balance

 

$

2,903

 

$

9,181

 

Tax positions taken during the current period

 

259

 

-

 

Changes in tax positions taken during a prior period

 

415

 

231

 

Changes due to lapse in statute of limitations

 

(1,179

)

-

 

Impact of foreign currency remeasurement on unrecognized tax benefits in the current period

 

164

 

(825

)

Changes resulting from settlements with taxing authorities

 

-

 

(5,684

)

Unrecognized tax benefits, ending balance

 

$

2,562

 

$

2,903

 

 

When there is uncertainty in a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return, a liability is recorded for the amount of the position that could be challenged and overturned through any combination of audit, appeals or litigation processes.  This amount is determined through criteria and a methodology prescribed by ASC Topic 740 and is referred to as an “unrecognized tax benefit.”

 

We do not expect any material changes to our existing unrecognized tax benefits during the next twelve months resulting from any issues currently pending with tax authorities.

 

91



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 9 - INCOME TAXES, CONTINUED

 

We file income tax returns in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and various states and foreign jurisdictions.  As of February 28, 2010, tax years under examination or still subject to examination by major tax jurisdictions, for our most significant subsidiaries were as follows:

 

Jurisdiction

 

Examinations in Process

 

Open Years

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mexico

 

- None -

 

2004        -         2009

 

United Kingdom

 

- None -

 

2009        -         2010

 

United States

 

2007      -      2008

 

2007        -         2010

 

 

NOTE 10 – FAIR VALUE

 

In the first quarter of fiscal 2009, we adopted the fair value measurement provisions of ASC Topic 820 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures”, which defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value under GAAP, and requires expanded disclosures about fair value measurements. ASC Topic 820 does not require any new fair value measurements, but rather generally applies to other accounting topics that require or permit fair value measurements.  The topic emphasizes that fair value is a market-based measurement, not an entity-specific measurement, and defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. The topic discusses valuation techniques, such as the market approach (comparable market prices), the income approach (present value of future income or cash flow), and the cost approach (cost to replace the service capacity of an asset or replacement cost). These valuation techniques are based upon observable and unobservable inputs. Observable inputs reflect market data obtained from independent sources, while unobservable inputs reflect the Company’s market assumptions.

 

On June 1, 2009, we adopted the interim disclosure provisions about the fair value of financial instruments as required by ASC Topic 820.  These provisions require disclosures about the fair value of financial instruments, previously only required in annual financial statements, to be included in interim financial statements. These provisions also require the disclosure in interim financial statements of methods and significant assumptions used to estimate the fair value of financial instruments and any changes of the methods and significant assumptions from prior periods.  On March 1, 2009, we adopted the fair value measurement provisions as required by the topic, as it relates to our non-financial assets and liabilities measured on a non-recurring basis.  The Company’s financial assets and liabilities, which are adjusted to fair value at the end of each reporting period presented in these consolidated financial statements, are money market accounts, commercial paper, auction rate securities, trading securities, foreign currency contracts and interest rate swaps.

 

92



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 10 – FAIR VALUE, CONTINUED

 

The following tables present the fair value hierarchy of our financial assets and liabilities carried at fair value and measured on a recurring basis as of the last day of February 2010 and 2009:

 

FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

 

 

 

 

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in

 

Significant Other

 

Significant

 

 

 

 

 

Active Markets

 

Observable

 

Unobservable

 

 

 

Fair Value at

 

for Identical Assets

 

Market Inputs

 

Inputs

 

Description

 

February 28, 2010

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Money market accounts

 

$

14,099

 

$

14,099

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Commercial paper

 

88,822

 

88,822

 

 

 

 

 

Auction rate securities

 

20,534

 

-

 

-

 

20,534

 

Foreign currency contracts

 

795

 

-

 

795

 

-

 

Total assets

 

$

124,250

 

$

102,921

 

$

795

 

$

20,534

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term debt - fixed rate (1)

 

$

9,600

 

$

-

 

$

9,600

 

$

-

 

Long-term debt - floating rate

 

125,000

 

-

 

125,000

 

-

 

Interest rate swaps

 

12,021

 

-

 

12,021

 

-

 

Total liabilities

 

$

146,621

 

$

-

 

$

146,621

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in

 

Significant Other

 

Significant

 

 

 

 

 

Active Markets

 

Observable

 

Unobservable

 

 

 

Fair Value at

 

for Identical Assets

 

Market Inputs

 

Inputs

 

Description

 

February 28, 2009

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Money market accounts

 

$

82,674

 

$

82,674

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Trading securities

 

570

 

570

 

-

 

-

 

Auction rate securities

 

19,973

 

-

 

-

 

19,973

 

Foreign currency contracts

 

819

 

-

 

819

 

-

 

Total assets

 

$

104,036

 

$

83,244

 

$

819

 

$

19,973

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term debt - fixed rate (1)

 

$

12,441

 

$

-

 

$

12,441

 

$

-

 

Long-term debt - floating rate

 

200,000

 

-

 

200,000

 

-

 

Interest rate swaps

 

13,870

 

-

 

13,870

 

-

 

Total liabilities

 

$

226,311

 

$

-

 

$

226,311

 

$

-

 

 

(1)  Debt values are reported at estimated fair value in this table, but are recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at the undiscounted value of remaining principal payments due.

 

Money market accounts and commercial paper are included in cash and cash equivalents in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and are classified as Level 1 assets.  Trading securities are also classified as Level 1 assets because they consist of certain publicly traded stocks which are stated on our consolidated balance sheets at market value, as determined by the most recent trading price of each security as of the balance sheet date.

 

We classify our auction rate securities (“ARS”) as Level 3 assets because we determine their estimated fair values with discounted cash flow models.  Some of the inputs factored into the discounted cash flow models we use are unobservable in the market and have a significant effect on valuation.  The assumptions used in preparing the models include, but are not limited to, periodic coupon rates, market required rates of return and the expected term of each security. The coupon rate was estimated using implied forward rate data on interest rate swaps and U.S. treasuries, and limited where necessary

 

93



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 10 – FAIR VALUE, CONTINUED

 

by any contractual maximum rate paid under a scenario of continuing auction failures.  We believe implied forward rates inherently account for a lack of liquidity.  In making assumptions of the required rates of return, we considered risk-free interest rates and credit spreads for investments of similar credit quality. The expected term was based on a weighted probability-based estimate of the time the principal will become available to us. The principal can become available under three different scenarios: (1) the ARS is called; (2) the market has returned to normal and auctions have recommenced and are successful; and (3) the principal has reached maturity.

 

We classify our fixed and floating rate debt as Level 2 liabilities because the estimation of the fair market value of debt requires the use of a discount rate based upon current market rates of interest for debt with comparable remaining terms.  Such comparable rates are considered significant other observable market inputs. The fair market value of the fixed rate debt at February 28, 2010 was computed using a discounted cash flow analysis and discount rate of 2.89 percent.  All other long-term debt has floating interest rates, and its book value approximates its fair value as of the reporting date.

 

We use derivatives for hedging purposes and our derivatives are primarily foreign currency contracts and interest rate swaps. We determine the fair value of our derivative instruments based on Level 2 inputs in the fair value hierarchy. See Notes (1) and (11) to these consolidated financial statements for more information on our hedging activities.

 

The Company’s other non-financial assets include goodwill and other intangible assets, which we classify as Level 3 assets. These assets are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as part of the Company’s impairment assessments and as circumstances require.

 

The table below presents a reconciliation of our assets measured and recorded at fair value on a recurring basis and other non-financial assets measured on a non-recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for the fiscal years 2010 and 2009:

 

FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS USING SIGNIFICANT UNOBSERVABLE INPUTS (Level 3)

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

 

 

Non-Financial

 

 

 

Non-Financial

 

 

 

ARS

 

Assets

 

ARS

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning balances

 

$

19,973

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Transfers into Level 3 at June 1, 2008

 

-

 

-

 

47,067

 

-

 

Transfers into Level 3 at March 1, 2009

 

-

 

309,791

 

-

 

-

 

Total gains (losses):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Included in earnings - realized

 

-

 

(7,028

)

-

 

-

 

Included in other comprehensive income (loss) - unrealized

 

811

 

-

 

(1,169

)

-

 

Acquired during the period

 

-

 

60,516

 

-

 

-

 

Acquisition adjustments during the period

 

-

 

(218

)

-

 

-

 

Sales at par

 

(250

)

-

 

(25,925

)

-

 

Ending balances

 

$

20,534

 

$

363,061

 

$

19,973

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cumulative unrealized losses relating to assets still held at each reporting date, net of taxes

 

$

(1,232

)

 

 

$

(1,767

)

 

 

 

94



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 11 – FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK MANAGEMENT

 

Foreign Currency Risk - Our functional currency is the U.S. Dollar. By operating internationally, we are subject to foreign currency risk from transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar (“foreign currencies”).  Such transactions include sales, certain inventory purchases and operating expenses. As a result of such transactions, portions of our cash, trade accounts receivable, and trade accounts payable are denominated in foreign currencies.  For the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, 14.8, 16.9 and 16.8 percent of our net sales revenue was in foreign currencies.  These sales were primarily denominated in the British Pound, Euro, Mexican Peso, Canadian Dollar, Brazilian Real, Chilean Pesos, Peruvian Soles and Venezuelan Bolivares Fuertes. We make most of our inventory purchases from the Far East and use the U.S. Dollar for such purchases.  In our consolidated statements of income, exchange gains and losses resulting from the remeasurement of foreign taxes receivable, taxes payable, deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities, are recognized in their respective income tax lines, and all other foreign exchange gains and losses are recognized in SG&A.    We recorded net foreign exchange gains (losses), including the impact of currency hedges, of $1.73, ($5.21) and $0.53 million in SG&A and $0.05, $0.62 and $0.22 million in income tax expense during fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

We have historically hedged against certain foreign currency exchange rate-risk by using a series of forward contracts designated as cash flow hedges to protect against the foreign currency exchange risk inherent in our forecasted transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar.  We do not enter into any forward exchange contracts or similar instruments for trading or other speculative purposes.

 

On September 3, 2008, the Company entered into a series of foreign exchange forward contracts to sell U.S.  Dollars for British Pounds in notional amounts and terms that effectively froze the $1.78 million fair value of our existing forward contracts to sell British Pounds for U.S. Dollars.  The new forward contracts had the effect of eliminating the foreign currency hedge created by the original forward currency contracts on certain forecasted transactions denominated in British Pounds and we discontinued their classification as cash flow hedges.  These forward contracts had originally been designated as cash flow hedges.  In accordance with GAAP, the net gain related to the discontinued cash flow hedges  continued to be reported in accumulated other comprehensive loss at February 28, 2009, and was reclassified into income when the underlying contracts settled over dates ranging from May 15, 2009 through August 17, 2009.

 

Interest Rate Risk – Interest on our long-term debt outstanding as of February 28, 2010 is both floating and fixed.  Fixed rates are in place on $9 million of Senior Notes at 7.24 percent and floating rates are in place on $125 million of Senior Notes, which reset as described in Note (8), and have been effectively converted to fixed rate debt using the interest rate swaps, as described below.

 

We manage our floating rate debt using interest rate swaps.  As of February 28, 2010, we had two swaps that converted an aggregate notional principal of $125 million from floating interest rate payments under our 7 and 10 year Senior Notes to fixed interest rate payments at 5.89 and 6.01 percent, respectively.  In the swap transactions, we maintain two contracts to pay fixed rates of interest on an aggregate notional principal amount of $125 million at rates of 5.04 and 5.11 percent on our 7 and 10 year Senior Notes, respectively, while simultaneously receiving floating rate interest payments set at 0.25 percent as of February 28, 2010 on the same notional amounts.  The fixed rate side of the swap will not change over the life of the swap.  The floating rate payments are reset quarterly based on three month LIBOR.  The resets are concurrent with the interest payments made on the underlying debt. Changes in the spread between the fixed rate payment side of the swap and the floating rate receipt side of the swap offset 100 percent of the change in any period of the underlying debt’s floating rate payments.  These swaps are used to reduce the Company’s risk of increased interest costs; however, when interest rates drop significantly below the swap rates, we lose the benefit that our floating rate debt would provide, if not managed with swaps. The swaps are considered 100 percent effective.

 

95



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 11 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK MANAGEMENT, CONTINUED

 

The following table summarizes the fair values of our various derivative instruments at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009:

 

FAIR VALUES OF DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS IN THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

February 28. 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative

 

and Other

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notional

 

Assets,

 

Current

 

Liabilities,

 

Designated as hedging Instuments

 

Hedge Type

 

Term

 

Amount

 

Current

 

Liabilities

 

Noncurrent

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Pounds

 

Cash flow

 

10/2010- 2/2011

 

£

5,000

 

$

651

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Canadian

 

Cash flow

 

10/2010 - 12/2010

 

$

6,000

 

144

 

-

 

-

 

Subtotal

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

795

 

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

Cash flow

 

6/2011- 6/2014

 

$

125,000

 

-

 

4,951

 

7,070

 

Total fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

795

 

$

4,951

 

$

7,070

 

 

 

February 28. 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative

 

and Other

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notional

 

Assets,

 

Current

 

Liabilities,

 

Designated as hedging Instuments

 

Hedge Type

 

Term

 

Amount

 

Current

 

Liabilities

 

Noncurrent

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Pounds

 

Ordinary

 

5/2009 - 8/2009

 

£

4,000

 

$

2,117

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Foreign currency contracts - sell Dollars

 

Ordinary

 

5/2009 - 8/2009

 

$

7,011

 

(1,298

)

-

 

-

 

Subtotal

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

819

 

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swaps

 

Cash flow

 

6/2009 - 6/2014

 

$

200,000

 

-

 

4,853

 

9,017

 

Total fair value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

819

 

$

4,853

 

$

9,017

 

 

The pre-tax effect of derivative instruments for the fiscal years 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 

PRE TAX EFFECT OF DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS

 

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal Years Ended

 

 

 

 

 

Gain \ (Loss)

 

Gain \ (Loss) Reclassified

 

 

 

 

 

Recognized in OCI

 

from Accumulated Other

 

Gain \ (Loss) Recognized

 

 

 

(effective portion)

 

Comprehensive Loss into Income

 

as Income (1)

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

Location

 

2010

 

2009

 

Location

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency contracts - ordinary and cash flow hedges

 

$

7

 

$

2,204

 

SG&A

 

$

30

 

$

975

 

SG&A

 

$

12

 

$

166

 

Interest rate swap contracts - cash flow hedges

 

(4,661

)

(5,638

)

Interest expense

 

(6,510

)

(4,217

)

 

 

-

 

-

 

Total

 

$

(4,654

)

$

(3,434

)

 

 

$

(6,480

)

$

(3,242

)

 

 

$

12

 

$

166

 

 

(1)  The amounts shown represent the ineffective portion of the change in fair value of a cash flow hedge.

 

We expect gains of $0.8 million associated with foreign currency contracts which are currently reported in accumulated other comprehensive loss to be reclassified into income over the next year.  The amount ultimately realized, however, will differ as exchange rates change and the underlying contracts settle.

 

See Notes (1) and (10) to these consolidated financial statements for more information on our hedging activities.

 

96


 


Table of Contents

 

NOTE 11 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK MANAGEMENT, CONTINUED

 

Counterparty Credit Risk - Financial instruments, including foreign currency contracts and interest rate swaps, expose us to counterparty credit risk for nonperformance.  We manage our exposure to counterparty credit risk through only dealing with counterparties who are substantial international financial institutions with significant experience using such derivative instruments.  Although our theoretical credit risk is the replacement cost at the then estimated fair value of these instruments, we believe that the risk of incurring credit risk losses is remote.

 

Risks Inherent in Cash, Cash Equivalents and Investment Holdings — Our cash, cash equivalents and investments are subject to interest rate risk, credit risk and liquidity risk.  Cash consists of both interest-bearing and non interest-bearing disbursement or short-term investment accounts.  Cash equivalents consist of commercial paper and money market investment accounts.  Long-term investments consist of AAA rated ARS that we normally seek to dispose of within 35 or fewer days. The following table summarizes our cash, cash equivalents and long-term investments at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009:

 

CASH, CASH EQUIVALENTS AND LONG-TERM INVESTMENTS

(in thousands)

 

 

February 28, 2010

 

February 28, 2009

 

 

Carrying

 

Range of

 

Carrying

 

Range of

 

 

Amount

 

Interest Rates

 

Amount

 

Interest Rates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash, interest and non interest-bearing accounts - unrestricted

 

$

6,234

 

0.00 to 2.00%

 

$

18,575

 

0.00 to 3.00%

Cash, interest and non interest-bearing accounts - restricted

 

1,053

 

0.00 to 2.50%

 

1,426

 

0.00 to 7.00%

Commercial paper

 

88,822

 

0.03 to 0.18%

 

-    

 

-          

Money market funds

 

14,099

 

0.01 to 3.98%

 

82,674

 

0.35 to 6.00%

Total cash and cash equivalents

 

$

110,208

 

 

 

$

102,675

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term investments - auction rate securities

 

$

20,534

 

1.73 to 8.44%

 

$

19,973

 

1.95 to 8.67%

 

Our cash balances at end of fiscal 2010 and 2009 include restricted cash of $1.05 and $1.43 million, respectively, denominated in Venezuelan Bolivares Fuertes, shown above under the heading “Cash, interest and non interest-bearing accounts – restricted.” The balances are primarily a result of favorable operating cash flows within the Venezuelan market.  Due to continued Venezuelan government restrictions on transfers of cash out of the country and control of exchange rates, the Company has not yet received approval of its applications to repatriate this cash at an official exchange rate, and currently intends to use these balances to remain in-country and fund operations until such time as our applications are approved.  We do not otherwise rely on these restricted funds as a source of liquidity.

 

On January 8, 2010, the Venezuelan government announced its decision to devalue its currency and implement a two-tier exchange rate structure. As a result, the official exchange rate changed from 2.15 to 2.60 for essential goods and 4.30 for non-essential goods. We believe that our products are classified as non-essential goods and thus payments made for such goods are exchanged at the 4.30 rate.  In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2010, we remeasured the financial statements of our Venezuelan subsidiary at the rate at which we expect to remit dividends, which currently is 4.30. The $1.26 million impact of the devaluation was included in SG&A in fiscal 2010.

 

Most of our cash equivalents and investments are in commercial paper, money market accounts and ARS with frequent rate resets; therefore, we believe there is no material interest rate risk.  In addition, our commercial paper and ARS are from issuers with high credit ratings; therefore, we believe the credit risk is relatively low.

 

We hold investments in ARS collateralized by student loans (with underlying maturities from 19 to 36 years).  Substantially all of the collateral is guaranteed by the U.S. government under the Federal Family Education Loan Program.  Liquidity for these securities was normally dependent on an auction process that reset the applicable interest rate at pre-determined intervals, ranging from 7 to 35 days.  Beginning in February 2008, the auctions for the ARS held by

 

97



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 11 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS AND RISK MANAGEMENT, CONTINUED

 

us and others were unsuccessful, requiring us to hold them beyond their typical auction reset dates. Auctions fail when there is insufficient demand.  However, this does not represent a default by the issuer of the security. Upon an auction’s failure, the interest rates reset based on a formula contained in the security.  The securities will continue to accrue interest and be auctioned until one of the following occurs: the auction succeeds; the issuer calls the securities; or the securities mature.  ARS are currently classified as non-current assets held for sale under the heading “Other assets” in our consolidated balance sheets.

 

At fiscal year-end 2010 and 2009, we had cumulative pre-tax unrealized losses on our ARS of $1.87 and $2.68 million, respectively, which are reflected in accumulated other comprehensive loss in our accompanying consolidated balance sheets, net of related tax effects of $0.64 and $0.91 million, respectively.  The recording of these unrealized losses is not a result of the quality of the underlying collateral, but rather a markdown reflecting a lack of liquidity and other market conditions.  For the fiscal years ended February 2010 and 2009, we liquidated $0.25 and $41.18 million, respectively, of these securities at par.

 

NOTE 12 – OTHER COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

Indemnity Agreements - Under agreements with customers, licensors and parties from whom we have acquired assets or entered into business combinations, we indemnify these parties against liability associated with our products. Additionally, we are party to a number of agreements under leases where we indemnify the lessor for liabilities attributable to our actions or conduct.  The indemnity agreements to which we are a party do not, in general, increase our liability for claims related to our products or actions and have not materially affected our consolidated financial statements.

 

Employment Contracts - We have entered into employment contracts with certain of our officers. These agreements provide for minimum salary levels and potential incentive bonuses. One agreement automatically renews itself each day for a new three-year period and provides that in the event of a merger, consolidation or transfer of all or substantially all of our assets to an unaffiliated party, the officer will receive  a cash payment for the balance of the obligations under the agreement within six months of separation from service. The expiration dates for these agreements range from June 1, 2010 to February 28, 2013.  The aggregate commitment for future salaries pursuant to such contracts, at February 28, 2010, excluding incentive compensation, was $4.46 million.

 

On December 30, 2008, the Company’s Compensation Committee approved and the Company and Gerald J. Rubin, the Company’s Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President, executed a Second Amendment to Mr. Rubin’s employment agreement, effective as of December 30, 2009.  The intent of the amendment was to make the provisions of Mr. Rubin’s employment agreement comply with the applicable requirements of Sections 409A and 457A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.  The most substantive change was that prior to amendment, Mr. Rubin had the option to receive annual payments of certain obligations for three years from separation from service, or elect to receive a discounted cash lump sum payment of these obligation using prescribed interest rates to compute the discount.  The new amendment eliminates any election and requires a cash payment of the undiscounted balance of all obligations under the agreement within six months of separation from service.

 

International Trade - We purchase most of our appliances and a significant portion of other products that we sell from unaffiliated manufacturers located in the Far East, mainly in the Peoples’ Republic of China. Due to the fact that most of our products are manufactured in the Far East, we are subject to risks associated with trade barriers, currency exchange fluctuations and social, economic and political unrest.  In recent years, increasing labor costs, regional labor dislocations as a result of new government social policies, growing local inflation, changes in available ocean cargo carrier capacity and costs, the impact of energy prices on transportation and the appreciation of the Renminbi against the U.S. Dollar have resulted in fluctuations in our cost of goods sold.  Certain of our suppliers in China closed operations due to economic conditions that put rapid upward pressure on their operating costs. This caused and may continue to cause periodic disruptions in delivery of certain items which can affect our sales.  Although we have multiple sourcing partners for many of our products, from time to time we are unable to source certain items on a timely basis due to the rapid changes

 

98



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 12 – OTHER COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES, CONTINUED

 

occurring with our Chinese suppliers.  We believe that the contraction in suppliers continues to be a widespread issue in our industry, although it has been somewhat stable over the last year. Additionally, we believe that we could obtain similar products from facilities in other countries, if necessary, and we continue to explore expanding our sourcing alternatives in other countries. However, the relocation of any production capacity could require substantial time and increased costs.

 

Customer Incentives - We regularly enter into arrangements with customers whereby we offer those customers incentives, including incentives in the form of volume rebates. Our estimate of the liability for such incentives is included on the consolidated balance sheets on the line entitled “Accrued expenses and other current liabilities,” and in Note (7) included in the lines entitled “Accrued sales returns, discounts and allowances,” “Accrued advertising” and “Other” and is based on incentives applicable to sales up to the respective balance sheet dates.

 

Other Matters - We are involved in various legal claims and proceedings in the normal course of operations. We believe the outcome of these matters will not have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, results of operations, or liquidity.

 

Contractual Obligations and Commercial Commitments - Our contractual obligations and commercial commitments, as of February 28, 2010, were:

 

PAYMENTS DUE BY PERIOD - TWELVE MONTHS ENDED THE LAST DAY OF FEBRUARY

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

2011

 

2012

 

2013

 

2014

 

2015

 

After

 

 

 

Total

 

1 year

 

2 years

 

3 years

 

4 years

 

5 years

 

5 years

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Term debt - fixed rate

 

$

9,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,000

 

$

-    

 

$

-    

 

$

-    

 

Term debt - floating rate (1)

 

125,000

 

-    

 

50,000

 

-    

 

-    

 

75,000

 

-    

 

Long-term incentive plan payouts

 

4,958

 

2,339

 

1,505

 

1,114

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

Interest on fixed rate debt

 

896

 

516

 

299

 

81

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

Interest on floating rate debt (1)

 

23,459

 

7,453

 

5,489

 

4,507

 

4,507

 

1,503

 

-    

 

Open purchase orders

 

76,716

 

76,716

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

Minimum royalty payments

 

72,807

 

6,438

 

6,110

 

5,723

 

5,416

 

4,843

 

44,277

 

Advertising and promotional

 

80,625

 

8,712

 

6,146

 

6,168

 

5,559

 

5,328

 

48,712

 

Operating leases

 

11,795

 

2,023

 

1,721

 

1,416

 

1,348

 

1,267

 

4,020

 

Capital spending commitments

 

2,465

 

2,465

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

-    

 

Total contractual obligations (2)

 

$

407,721

 

$

109,662

 

$

74,270

 

$

22,009

 

$

16,830

 

$

87,941

 

$

97,009

 

 

(1)       The Company uses interest rate hedge agreements (the “swaps”)  in conjunction with its unsecured floating interest rate $50 million, 7 year and $75 million, 10 year Senior Notes.  The swaps are a hedge of the variable LIBOR rates used to reset the floating rates on these Senior Notes.  The swaps effectively fix the interest rates on the 7 and 10 year Senior Notes at 5.89 and 6.01 percent, respectively.   Accordingly, the future interest obligations related to this debt have been estimated using these rates.

 

(2)       In addition to the contractual obligations and commercial commitments in the table above, as of February 28, 2010, we have recorded a provision for our uncertain tax positions of $2.56 million. We are unable to reliably estimate the timing of future payments, if any, related to uncertain tax positions; therefore, we have excluded these tax liabilities from the table above.

 

99



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 13 – REPURCHASE OF HELEN OF TROY COMMON STOCK

 

Under the latest program approved by our Board of Directors, as of February 28, 2010 we are authorized to purchase up to 1,280,650 shares of common stock in the open market or through private transactions.   For the fiscal years ended 2010, 2009 and 2008, we repurchased and retired 47,648, 574,365 and 1,095,392 shares of common stock at a total purchase price of $0.42, $7.42 and $26.00 million, and an average purchase price of $8.80, $12.91 and $23.74 per share, respectively.  In addition, during the fiscal quarters ended May 31, 2009 and November 30, 2009, our chief executive officer tendered certain shares of common stock as payment for the exercise price and related federal tax obligations arising from the exercise of options.   We accounted for this activity as a purchase and retirement of the shares.   The table below summarizes these option exercise transactions:

 

SHARES TENDERED FOR THE EXERCISE OF OPTIONS FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28, 2010

Transaction Date

 

Total Number of
Shares Subject to
Options
Exercised

 

Total Number of
Shares Tendered
in Payment of the
Exercise Price
and Related
Federal Taxes

 

Fair Market
Value of shares at
the Transaction
Date
(in thousands)

 

Average Price
per Share
Tendered

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

May 14, 2009

 

1,000,000

 

762,519

 

$

14,600

 

$

19.15

 

October 8, 2009

 

1,000,000

 

675,590

 

15,552

 

23.02

 

Totals / average

 

2,000,000

 

1,438,109

 

$

30,152

 

$

20.97

 

 

There was no repurchase activity for the last quarter of fiscal 2010.

 

NOTE 14 – SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS

 

We have equity awards outstanding under two expired share-based compensation plans.  The expired plans consist of an employee stock option and restricted stock plan adopted in 1998 (the “1998 Plan”) and a non-employee director stock option plan adopted in 1995 (the “1995 Directors’ Plan”).  During fiscal 2008, an employee stock purchase plan adopted in 1998 (the “1998 Stock Purchase Plan”) expired and the last stock options outstanding under a stock option and restricted stock plan adopted in 1994 were exercised.  Therefore, these plans are no longer in effect.

 

On August 19, 2008, at our Annual General Meeting of the Shareholders, our shareholders approved three new share- based compensation plans. The new plans consist of the Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Stock Incentive Plan, an employee stock option and restricted stock plan (the “2008 Stock Incentive Plan”), the Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Non-Employee Directors Stock Incentive Plan, a non-employee director restricted stock plan (the “2008 Directors’ Plan”), and the Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “2008 Stock Purchase Plan”).  These plans are described below.  The plans are administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors, which consists of non-employee directors who are independent under the Nasdaq Stock Market listing standards.

 

Expired Plans

 

The 1998 Plan covered a total of 6,750,000 shares of common stock for issuance to key officers and employees. The 1998 Plan provided for the grant of options to purchase our common stock at a price equal to or greater than the fair market value on the grant date. The 1998 Plan contained provisions for incentive stock options, non-qualified stock options and restricted share grants. Generally, options granted under the 1998 Plan become exercisable immediately or over one-, four-, or five-year vesting periods and expire on dates ranging from seven to ten years from the date of grant. The 1998 Plan expired by its terms on August 25, 2008.  As of  February 28, 2010, 2,454,976 shares of common stock subject to options were outstanding under the plan.

 

100



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 14 - SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS, CONTINUED

 

The 1995 Directors’ Plan covered a total of 980,000 shares of common stock for issuance to non-employee members of the Board of Directors. We granted options under the 1995 Directors’ Plan at a price equal to the fair market value of our common stock at the date of grant. Options granted under the 1995 Directors’ Plan vest one year from the date of issuance and expire ten years after issuance. The 1995 Directors’ Plan expired by its terms on June 6, 2005.  As of February 28, 2010, options to purchase 160,000 shares of common stock were outstanding under the plan.

 

The 1998 Stock Purchase Plan initially covered a total of 500,000 shares of common stock for issuance to our employees. Under the terms of the 1998 Stock Purchase Plan, employees authorized the withholding of up to 15 percent of their wages or salaries to purchase our common stock. The purchase price for stock acquired under the 1998 Stock Purchase Plan is equal to the lower of 85 percent of the stocks’ fair market value on either the first day of each option period or the last day of each period. The 1998 Stock Purchase Plan expired by its own terms on July 17, 2008 with 234,889 shares of common stock issued under the plan.

 

Active Plans

 

The 2008 Stock Incentive Plan covers a total of 750,000 shares of common stock for issuance to key officers, employees and consultants of the Company. The plan provides for the grant of options to purchase our common stock at a price equal to or greater than the fair market value on the grant date. The plan contains provisions for incentive stock options, non-qualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units or other stock-based awards. Gerald J. Rubin, the Company’s Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President, is not eligible to participate in the plan. The maximum number of shares with respect to which awards of any and all types may be granted during a calendar year to any participant is limited, in the aggregate, to 250,000 shares. Generally, options granted under the 2008 Stock Incentive Plan will become exercisable over four or five-year vesting periods and will expire on dates ranging from seven to ten years from the date of grant. The plan will expire by its terms on August 19, 2018.  As of February 28, 2010, 283,800 shares of common stock subject to options were outstanding and 466,200 shares remained available for future issue under the plan.

 

The 2008 Directors’ Plan covers a total of 175,000 shares of common stock for issuance of restricted stock, restricted stock units or other stock-based awards to non-employee members of the Board of Directors.  Awards granted under the 2008 Directors’ Plan will be subject to vesting schedules and other terms and conditions as determined by the Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors. The plan will expire by its terms on August 19, 2018.  As of February 28, 2010, 8,000 shares of restricted stock have been granted and 167,000 shares remained available for future issue under the plan.

 

The 2008 Stock Purchase Plan covers a total of 350,000 shares of common stock for issuance to our employees. Under the terms of the plan, employees may authorize the withholding of up to 15 percent of their wages or salaries to purchase our shares of common stock.  The purchase price for shares acquired under the 2008 Stock Purchase Plan is equal to the lower of 85 percent of the share’s fair market value on either the first day of each option period or the last day of each period. The plan will expire by its terms on September 1, 2018.  During the second and fourth quarters of fiscal 2010, plan participants acquired 17,652 and 11,130 shares of common stock, respectively at prices of $8.53 and $17.61 per share, respectively.  As of February 28, 2010, 305,736 shares remained available for future issue under this plan.

 

101



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 14 - SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS, CONTINUED

 

The Company recorded share-based compensation expense in SG&A for each of the fiscal years covered by our consolidated statements of income as follows:

 

SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION EXPENSE

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February,

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stock options

 

$

1,403

 

$

1,331

 

$

1,007

 

Restricted stock grants

 

176

 

-    

 

$

-    

 

Employee stock purchase plan

 

165

 

157

 

155

 

Share-based payment expense

 

1,744

 

1,488

 

1,162

 

Less income tax benefits

 

(87

)

(88

)

(192

)

Share-based payment expense, net of income tax benefits

 

$

1,657

 

$

1,400

 

$

970

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings per share impact of share-based payment expense:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.03

 

Diluted

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.05

 

$

0.03

 

 

The fair value of all share-based payment awards are estimated using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008:

 

ASSUMPTIONS USED FOR FAIR VALUE OF STOCK OPTION GRANTS

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February,

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Range of risk free interest rates used

 

1.7% - 2.0%

 

2.7% - 3.0%

 

3.0% - 5.1%

Expected dividend rate

 

0.0%

 

0.0%

 

0.0%

Weighted average volatility rate

 

50.6%

 

46.2%

 

38.1%

Range of expected volatility rates used

 

45.5% - 55.5%

 

45.8% - 46.5%

 

37.0% - 42.5%

Range of expected terms used (in years)

 

4.1 - 4.6

 

3.1 - 4.6

 

3.3 - 4.6

 

The following describes how certain assumptions affecting the estimated fair value of options or discounted employee share purchases (“share-based payments”) are determined.  The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury securities with maturities equal to the expected life of the share-based payments.  The dividend yield is computed as zero because the Company has not historically paid dividends nor does it expect to do so at this time.  Expected volatility is based on a weighted average of the market implied volatility and historical volatility over the expected life of the underlying share- based payments.  The Company uses its historical experience to estimate the expected life of each stock-option grant and also to estimate the impact of exercise, forfeitures, termination and holding period behavior for fair value expensing purposes.

 

Shares of common stock purchased under the 1998 Stock Purchase Plan and the 2008 Stock Purchase Plan vest immediately at the time of purchase.  Accordingly, the fair value award associated with their discounted purchase price is expensed at the time of purchase.

 

Under the 2008 Directors’ Plan, the Company granted 8,000 shares of restricted stock to certain board members in fiscal 2010 having a fair value at the date of grant of $21.97 per share.  The restricted stock awards vested immediately, were valued at the fair value of the Company’s common stock at the date of the grant and accordingly, were expensed at the time of grant.

 

102



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 14 - SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS, CONTINUED

 

A summary of option activity under all the Company’s share-based compensation plans follows:

 

SUMMARY OF OPTION ACTIVITY

(in thousands, except contractual term and per share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

Weighted

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

Average

 

Remaining

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise

 

Grant Date

 

Contractual

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Price

 

Fair Value

 

Term

 

Intrinsic

 

 

 

Options

 

(per share)

 

(per share)

 

(in years)

 

Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at February 28, 2007

 

6,751

 

$

15.01

 

$

5.57

 

3.87

 

$

56,211

 

Grants

 

324

 

25.40

 

8.89

 

 

 

 

 

Exercises

 

(1,157

)

(15.80

)

 

 

 

 

13,465

 

Forfeitures / expirations

 

(95

)

(20.60

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at February 29, 2008

 

5,823

 

15.34

 

5.58

 

3.69

 

14,171

 

Grants

 

250

 

22.46

 

8.66

 

 

 

 

 

Exercises

 

(48

)

(12.64

)

 

 

 

 

302

 

Forfeitures / expirations

 

(1,189

)

(16.82

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at February 28, 2009

 

4,836

 

15.37

 

5.61

 

3.37

 

1,039

 

Grants

 

306

 

18.77

 

7.81

 

 

 

 

 

Exercises

 

(2,142

)

(11.83

)

 

 

 

 

20,044

 

Forfeitures / expirations

 

(101

)

(21.53

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at February 28, 2010

 

2,899

 

$

18.13

 

$

6.57

 

4.06

 

$

18,742

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercisable at February 28, 2010

 

2,215

 

$

17.06

 

$

6.01

 

3.22

 

$

16,669

 

 

A summary of non-vested option activity and changes under all the Company’s share-based compensation plans follows:

 

NON-VESTED OPTION ACTIVITY

(in thousands, except per share data)

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

Grant Date

 

 

 

Non-Vested

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

Options

 

(per share)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding at February 28, 2007

 

344

 

$

7.41

 

Grants

 

324

 

8.89

 

Vested or forfeited

 

(123

)

(7.01

)

Outstanding at February 29, 2008

 

545

 

8.38

 

Grants

 

250

 

8.66

 

Vested or forfeited

 

(220

)

(8.25

)

Outstanding at February 28, 2009

 

575

 

8.55

 

Grants

 

306

 

7.81

 

Vested or forfeited

 

(197

)

(7.92

)

Outstanding at February 28, 2010

 

684

 

$

8.40

 

 

103



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 14 - SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS, CONTINUED

 

A summary of our total unrecognized share-based compensation expense as of February 28, 2010 is as follows:

 

UNRECOGNIZED SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION EXPENSE

(in thousands, except weighted average expense period data)

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

Unrecognized

 

Period of

 

 

 

Compensation

 

Recognition

 

 

 

Expense

 

(in months)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stock options

 

$

3,898

 

33.7

 

 

The following table summarizes additional information about options outstanding at February 28, 2010:

 

SUMMARY OF OPTIONS OUTSTANDING AND EXERCISABLE

(actual number of shares)

 

 

 

Outstanding Stock Options

 

 

 

Exercisable Stock Options

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted-

 

Weighted-

 

 

 

Weighted-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

Average

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise

 

Remaining

 

Exercise

 

 

 

Exercise

 

 

 

Number of

 

Price Range

 

Contractual

 

Price

 

Number of

 

Price

 

 

 

Options

 

(per share)

 

Term (years)

 

(per share)

 

Options

 

(per share)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ISOs

 

34,000

 

$   9.29

to

$ 14.02

 

3.36

 

$

11.51

 

29,000

 

$

11.89

 

 

 

338,565

 

$ 15.51

to

$ 21.21

 

6.45

 

18.81

 

93,099

 

18.93

 

 

 

207,574

 

$ 21.94

to

$ 22.91

 

6.94

 

22.51

 

35,321

 

22.59

 

 

 

291,825

 

$ 23.38

to

$ 33.88

 

4.38

 

26.45

 

166,000

 

26.56

 

Total

 

871,964

 

 

 

 

 

5.75

 

$

21.96

 

323,420

 

$

22.61

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-Qs

 

1,000,000

 

$ 10.08

to

$ 13.13

 

2.63

 

$

12.02

 

1,000,000

 

$

12.02

 

 

 

365,886

 

$ 14.94

to

$ 21.21

 

3.77

 

16.31

 

313,320

 

15.90

 

 

 

421,750

 

$ 21.47

to

$ 22.81

 

3.82

 

21.97

 

379,675

 

21.92

 

 

 

79,176

 

$ 22.91

to

$ 27.37

 

5.30

 

24.14

 

38,929

 

23.77

 

Total

 

1,866,812

 

 

 

 

 

3.24

 

$

15.62

 

1,731,924

 

$

15.15

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Directors’ Plan

 

32,000

 

$ 21.47

to

$ 22.81

 

3.63

 

$

22.14

 

32,000

 

$

22.14

 

 

 

128,000

 

$ 23.13

to

$ 33.35

 

4.70

 

27.60

 

128,000

 

27.60

 

Total

 

160,000

 

 

 

 

 

4.48

 

$

26.51

 

160,000

 

$

26.51

 

 

NOTE 15 - 401(k) DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLANS

 

We sponsor defined contribution savings plans in the U.S. and other countries where we have employees.  For calendar year 2009, the Company elected to discontinue its matching contributions to its U.S. based plan as a temporary cost reduction measure.  The Company has announced it will resume the U.S. match for calendar year 2010. Total matching contributions made to these savings plans for the fiscal years ended 2010, 2009 and 2008 were $0.31, $0.65 and $0.71 million, respectively.

 

104



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 16 – OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

 

The components of comprehensive income (loss), net of tax, for each of the years covered by this report are as follows:

 

COMPONENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

(in thousands)

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (Loss)

 

$

71,817

 

$

(56,793

)

$

61,509

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flow hedges - interest rate swaps, net of tax (1)

 

1,220

 

(938

)

(7,225

)

Cash flow and ordinary hedges - foreign currency, net of tax (2)

 

(35

)

762

 

440

 

Unrealized gain (loss) - auction rate securities, net of tax (3)

 

535

 

(1,767

)

-    

 

Comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

$

73,537

 

$

(58,736

)

$

54,724

 

 

The components of accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009 are as follows:

 

COMPONENTS OF ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS

(in thousands)

 

 

Last Day of February

 

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized holding losses on cash flow hedges - interest rate swaps, net of tax (1)

 

$

(7,934

)

$

(9,154

)

Unrealized holding gains on cash flow and ordinary hedges - foreign currency, net of tax (2)

 

592

 

627

 

Temporary impairment loss on auction rate securities, net of tax (3)

 

(1,232

)

(1,767

)

Total accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax

 

$

(8,574

)

$

(10,294

)

 

 

(1)

The change in unrealized losses on interest rate swap cash flow hedges is recorded net of tax benefits (expense) of $(0.63), $0.48 and $3.72 million, respectively, for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008. The unrealized holding loss on interest rate swap cash flow hedges included in accumulated other comprehensive loss, includes net deferred tax benefits of $4.09 and $4.72 million at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

 

(2)

The change in unrealized gains on foreign currency cash flow and ordinary hedges is recorded net of tax benefits (expense) of $0.00, $(0.30) and $(0.19) million, respectively, for the fiscal years 2010, 2009 and 2008. The unrealized holding gains on foreign currency cash flow and ordinary hedges included in accumulated other comprehensive loss, includes net deferred tax expense of $0.24 million for both fiscal 2010 and 2009.

 

 

(3)

The change in temporary impairment loss on auction rate securities is recorded net of tax benefits (expense) of $(0.28) and $0.91 million, respectively, for the fiscal years 2010 and 2009. The temporary impairment loss on auction rate securities included in accumulated other comprehensive loss, includes net deferred tax benefits of $0.63 and $0.91 million at the end of fiscal 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

105



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 17 - SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

Selected unaudited quarterly financial data is as follows (in thousands, except per share amounts):

 

 

 

May

 

August

 

November

 

February

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal 2010:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

143,873

 

$

162,193

 

$

189,399

 

$

152,161

 

$

647,626

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

58,509

 

68,894

 

83,522

 

68,231

 

279,156

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-   

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

-    

 

900

 

-    

 

-    

 

900

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-   

 

 

 

Net income

 

14,509

 

15,911

 

24,733

 

16,664

 

71,817

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings per share (1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

0.49

 

0.53

 

0.81

 

0.55

 

2.38

 

Diluted

 

0.47

 

0.51

 

0.80

 

0.54

 

2.32

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fiscal 2009:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

145,003

 

$

153,543

 

$

185,619

 

$

138,580

 

$

622,745

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

 

63,021

 

65,144

 

73,544

 

53,693

 

255,402

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset impairment charges

 

7,760

 

-    

 

-    

 

99,514

 

107,274

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

 

5,558

 

10,598

 

15,090

 

(88,039

)

(56,793

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings (loss) per share (1)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

0.18

 

0.35

 

0.50

 

(2.93

)

(1.88

)

Diluted

 

0.18

 

0.34

 

0.48

 

(2.93

)

(1.88

)

 

(1)

Earnings per share calculations for each quarter are based on the weighted average number of shares outstanding for each period, and the sum of the quarterly amounts may not necessarily equal the annual earnings per share amounts.

 

NOTE 18 - FOURTH QUARTER CHARGES/TRANSACTIONS

 

Fiscal 2010 — Our results for the fourth quarter of fiscal 2010 did not contain any transactions of a non-routine nature, other than the recording of a $1.26 million impact of a devaluation of Venezuelan currency recorded in SG&A and further discussed under Note (11) to these consolidated financial statements.

 

Fiscal 2009 - As more fully discussed in Note (4) to these consolidated financial statements, as a result of the continued deterioration of economic conditions during the second half of fiscal 2009, the Company evaluated the impact of these conditions and other developments on its reporting units to assess whether impairment indicators were present that would require interim impairment testing. During the latter half of the third quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company’s total market capitalization began to decline below the Company’s consolidated stockholders’ equity balance at November 30, 2008.  If a company’s total market capitalization remains below its consolidated stockholders’ equity balance for a sustained period of time, this may be an indicator of potential impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets.  Because this condition continued throughout the balance of the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company determined that the carrying amount of our goodwill and other intangible assets might not be recoverable and performed additional impairment testing as of February 28, 2009.

 

The impairment testing for the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009 was performed using an updated outlook for the Company’s reporting units completed in connection with its annual planning process.  This outlook included downward adjustments to certain future expected revenues and increases in the market participant discount rates, when compared to the projections and discount rates upon which our annual impairment tests were prepared during the first quarter of fiscal 2009.  The Company decreased its expected revenues in response to the reduction in consumer spending during the

 

106



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 18 - FOURTH QUARTER CHARGES/TRANSACTIONS, CONTINUED

 

second half of fiscal 2009 and its expectation that depressed spending levels would persist into 2010.  Our projections assumed a continued but decelerating economic contraction through the first half of fiscal 2011, an economic recovery beginning in the second half of fiscal 2011 and general economic growth returning to slightly above mean levels in fiscal years 2012 through 2014.  Additionally, the Company increased the market participant discount rates used in its analysis because management believes that the lending market and the restrained liquidity in the current environment have increased the cost of capital.  In determining the extent to which to change its assumptions, management considered consumer spending trends and the anticipated impact on each reporting unit as well as the market cost of capital for comparable companies for each reporting unit.

 

As a result, the Company recorded non-cash impairment charges of $99.51 million ($99.06 million after tax) in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009.  This consisted of non-cash, pre-tax impairment charges of $46.49 million against goodwill and $2.75 million against a trademark in our Personal Care segment’s Appliances and Accessories reporting unit, and $50.27 million against certain trademarks and an indefinite-lived license held by our Grooming, Skin Care and Hair Care Solutions reporting unit.  The impairment for these reporting units was due to a decrease in the fair value of forecasted cash flows, and other market conditions reflecting the continued deterioration of the domestic and global economies and the declines in retail sales activity.   No impairment charges were required for our Housewares segment as this reporting unit’s estimated fair value of total net assets including recorded goodwill, trademarks and other intangible assets, exceeded their carrying values as of the date of the evaluation.

 

In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the Company reversed $2.73 million of incentive compensation it had accrued throughout the year, due to the impact of the Company’s fourth quarter impairment charges on a management incentive plan.

 

Fiscal 2008 - In April 2008, we resolved all outstanding tax issues in connection with audits of our U.S. consolidated federal tax returns for fiscal years 2003 and 2004 which resulted in no adjustments to either year. As a result of the settlement, in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, we reversed $3.68 million representing the tax provisions, including interest and penalties previously established for those years. Of the $3.68 million, we credited $1.36 million to the fiscal 2008 tax provision and $2.32 million to additional paid-in-capital.  The amount credited to additional paid-in-capital was for the tax effects of prior year share-based compensation expense that was allowed upon audit. Also, in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, we increased our deferred tax valuation allowance $0.98 million to account for operating loss carryforwards in certain tax jurisdictions whose benefits we believe we will not be able to utilize.

 

107



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 19 - SEGMENT INFORMATION

 

The following table contains segment information for fiscal years covered by our consolidated financial statements:

 

FISCAL YEARS ENDED 2010, 2009 AND 2008

(in thousands)

 

 

Personal

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

Care

 

Housewares

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

449,151

 

$

198,475

 

$

647,626

 

Operating income before impairment and gain

 

46,515

 

43,754

 

90,269

 

Asset impairment charges

 

900

 

-    

 

900

 

Operating income

 

45,615

 

43,754

 

89,369

 

Identifiable assets

 

483,106

 

351,627

 

834,733

 

Capital, license, trademark and other intangible expenditures

 

4,622

 

3,093

 

7,715

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

9,424

 

5,837

 

15,261

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal

 

 

 

 

 

2009

 

Care

 

Housewares

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

447,244

 

$

175,501

 

$

622,745

 

Operating income before impairment and gain

 

41,432

 

25,626

 

67,058

 

Asset impairment charges

 

107,274

 

-    

 

107,274

 

Operating income (loss)

 

(65,842

)

25,626

 

(40,216

)

Identifiable assets

 

467,409

 

354,717

 

822,126

 

Capital, license, trademark and other intangible expenditures

 

1,914

 

3,945

 

5,859

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

9,055

 

5,130

 

14,185

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal

 

 

 

 

 

2008

 

Care

 

Housewares

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sales revenue, net

 

$

488,414

 

$

164,134

 

$

652,548

 

Operating income before impairment and gain

 

42,523

 

31,401

 

73,924

 

Asset impairment charges

 

4,983

 

-    

 

4,983

 

Gain on sale of land

 

3,609

 

-    

 

3,609

 

Operating income

 

41,149

 

31,401

 

72,550

 

Identifiable assets

 

552,329

 

359,664

 

911,993

 

Capital, license, trademark and other intangible expenditures

 

3,183

 

4,526

 

7,709

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

9,448

 

4,850

 

14,298

 

 

Our Personal Care segment’s products include hair dryers, straighteners, curling irons, hairsetters, shavers, mirrors, hot air brushes, home hair clippers and trimmers, paraffin baths, massage cushions, footbaths, body massagers, brushes, combs, hair accessories, liquid and aerosol hair styling products, men’s fragrances, men’s deodorants, liquid and bar soaps, shampoos, hair treatments, foot powder, body powder and skin care products.   Our Housewares segment reports the operations of the OXO family of brands whose products include kitchen tools, cutlery, bar and wine accessories, household cleaning tools, food storage containers, tea kettles, trash cans, storage and organization products, hand tools, gardening tools, kitchen mitts and trivets, barbeque tools and rechargeable lighting products.  We use third-party manufacturers to produce our goods.  Both our Personal Care and Housewares segments sell their products primarily through mass merchandisers, drugstore chains, warehouse clubs, catalogs, grocery stores and specialty stores.  In addition, the Personal Care segment sells extensively through beauty supply retailers and wholesalers.

 

We compute operating income for each segment based on net sales revenue, less cost of goods sold and any SG&A associated with the segment. The SG&A used to compute each segment’s operating income are comprised of SG&A directly associated with the segment, plus overhead expenses that are allocable to the segment.  We do not allocate other items

 

108



Table of Contents

 

NOTE 19 - SEGMENT INFORMATION, CONTINUED

 

of income and expense, including income taxes to operating segments.

 

Our domestic and international net sales revenue from third parties and long-lived assets for the years ended the last day of February are as follows:

 

 

 

Years Ended Last Day of February

 

 

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

SALES REVENUE, NET - FROM THIRD PARTIES:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

511,027

 

$

476,147

 

$

505,817

 

International

 

136,599

 

146,598

 

146,731

 

Total

 

$

647,626

 

$

622,745

 

$

652,548

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LONG-LIVED ASSETS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

109,435

 

$

113,631

 

$

123,624

 

Barbados

 

362,162

 

307,099

 

391,851

 

Other international

 

3,782

 

4,124

 

754

 

Total

 

$

475,379

 

$

424,854

 

$

516,229

 

 

The table above classifies assets based upon the country where we hold legal title.

 

Worldwide sales to our largest customer and its affiliates accounted for approximately 18, 17 and 19 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Sales within the U.S. to this same customer and its affiliates accounted 84, 85 and 86 percent of worldwide net sales revenue to the same customer and affiliates during fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

 

Sales to our second largest customer, all within the U.S. and Canada, accounted for approximately 10, 8 and 8 percent of our net sales revenue in fiscal 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  No other customers accounted for ten percent or more of net sales revenue during those fiscal years.

 

NOTE 20 — SUBSEQUENT EVENTS (UNAUDITED)

 

Management has evaluated subsequent events through the date these financial statements were issued, for both conditions existing and not existing as of February 28, 2010 and concluded that other than the event noted below, there were no additional subsequent events to recognize or disclose.

 

On March 31, 2010, we completed the acquisition of certain assets and liabilities of the Pert Plus hair care and Sure anti-perspirant and deodorant businesses from Innovative Brands, LLC for a net cash purchase price of $69 million (subject to certain potential post acquisition-adjustments), which we paid with cash on hand.  Net assets acquired consist principally of accounts receivable, finished goods inventories, prepaid expenses, goodwill, patents, trademarks, tradenames, product design specifications, production know-how, certain fixed assets, distribution rights and customer lists, less certain product related operating accruals and other current liabilities.  We have begun the process of completing our analysis of the economic lives of the assets acquired and appropriate allocation of the initial purchase price.

 

Pert Plus enjoys a long history as a leading brand in the $2 billion U.S. shampoo category through its pioneering development of the 2-in-1 shampoo and conditioner combination technology.  Sure is one of the leading brands in the $1.7 billion U.S. anti-perspirant and deodorant category, well known for its product efficacy and value to both women and men. We will market Pert Plus and Sure products primarily into retail trade channels.

 

109



Table of Contents

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED AND SUBSIDIARIES

Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

(in thousands)

 

 

 

 

 

Additions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Charged to

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning

 

 

cost and

 

Net charge to

 

 

 

 

Ending

 

Description

 

Balance

 

 

expenses (1)

 

sales revenue (2)

 

 

Deductions (3)

 

Balance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended February 28, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowances for doubtful accounts

 

$

1,916

 

 

$

448

 

$

-

 

 

$

974

 

$

1,390

 

Allowances for back-to-stock returns

 

1,840

 

 

-

 

116

 

 

-

 

$

1,956

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended February 28, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowances for doubtful accounts

 

$

1,331

 

 

$

5,643

 

$

-

 

 

$

5,058

 

$

1,916

 

Allowances for back-to-stock returns

 

6,877

 

 

-

 

(5,037

)

 

-

 

$

1,840

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year ended February 29, 2008

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowances for doubtful accounts

 

$

1,002

 

 

$

1,411

 

$

-

 

 

$

1,082

 

$

1,331

 

Allowances for back-to-stock returns

 

3,024

 

 

-

 

3,853

 

 

 

 

$

6,877

 

 

(1)

Represents periodic charges to the provision for doubtful accounts.

 

 

(2)

Represents net charges (credits) during the period to sales returns and allowances

 

 

(3)

Represents write-offs of doubtful accounts net of recoveries of previously reserved amounts.

 

110



Table of Contents

 

ITEM 9.

CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

EVALUATION OF DISCLOSURE CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

Under the supervision and with the participation of our Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and Chief Financial Officer (CFO), we have evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) promulgated under the Exchange Act as of February 28, 2010.  Based upon that evaluation, our CEO and CFO concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to ensure that information we are required to disclose in reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to management, including the CEO and CFO, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure and is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms.

 

MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

The management’s report on internal control over financial reporting and the attestation report on internal controls over financial reporting of the independent registered public accounting firm required by this item are set forth under “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this report on pages 63 through 64, and are incorporated herein by reference.

 

CHANGES IN INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING

 

In connection with the evaluation described above, we identified no change in our internal control over financial reporting as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) promulgated under the Exchange Act that occurred during our fiscal quarter ended February 28, 2010, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION

 

None.

 

111



Table of Contents

 

PART III

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS,  EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

Information in our Proxy Statement for the 2010 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders (the “Proxy Statement”) is incorporated by reference in response to this Item 10, as noted below:

 

·      Information about our Directors who are standing for reelection is set forth under “Election of Directors”;

 

·      Information about our executive officers is set forth under “Executive Officers”;

 

·      Information about our Audit Committee, including members of the committee, and our designated “audit committee financial experts” is set forth under “Corporate Governance, The Board, Board Committees and Meetings”; and

 

·      Information about Section 16(a) beneficial ownership reporting compliance is set forth under “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance.”

 

We have adopted a Code of Ethics governing our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial and Principal Accounting Officer, and finance department members.  The full text of our Code of Ethics is published on our website, at www.hotus.com, under the “Investor Relations-Corporate Governance” caption.  We intend to disclose future amendments to, or waivers from, certain provisions of this Code on our website or in a current report on Form 8-K.

 

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

 

Information set forth under the captions “Director Compensation”; “Executive Compensation”; and “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” in our Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference in response to this Item 11.

 

ITEM 12.  SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS

 

Information set forth under the captions “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” and “Executive Compensation” in our Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference in response to this Item 12.

 

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

 

Information set forth under the captions “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions” and “Corporate Governance, The Board, Board Committees and Meetings” in our Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference in response to this Item 13.

 

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

Information set forth under the caption “Audit and Other Fees Paid to our Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in our Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference in response to this Item 14.

 

112



Table of Contents

 

PART IV

 

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

(a)

1.

Financial Statements: See “Index to Consolidated Financial Statements” under Item 8 on page 62 of this report

 

 

 

 

2.

Financial Statement Schedule:  See “Schedule II” on page 110 of this report

 

 

 

 

3.

Exhibits

 

 

 

The exhibit numbers succeeded by an asterisk (*) indicate exhibits physically filed with this Form 10-K.  All other exhibit numbers indicate exhibits filed by incorporation by reference.  Exhibit numbers succeeded by a cross (†) are management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements.

 

3.1

Memorandum of Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-73594, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 30, 1993 (the “1993 S-4”)).

3.2

Bye-Laws, as Amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending August 31, 2007, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 10, 2007).

10.1†

Form of Directors’ and Executive Officers’ Indemnity Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the 1993 S-4).

10.2

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) North American Appliances License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending November 30, 1992 (the “November 1992 10-Q”)).

10.3

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) International Appliances License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.4

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) North American Comb and Brush License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.5

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) International Comb and Brush License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.6

First Amendment to RCPC North America Appliance License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for the year Ending February 28, 1993 (the “1993 10-K”).

10.7

First Amendment to RCPC North America Comb and Brush License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for the year Ending February 28, 1993 (the “1993 10-K”).

10.8

First Amendment to RCPC International Appliance License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to the 1993 10-K).

10.9

First Amendment to RCPC International Comb and Brush License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to the 1993 10-K).

10.10

Guaranteed Senior Notes and $40,000,000 Guaranteed Senior Note Facility (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending November 30, 1996 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 14, 1997).

10.11†

Helen of Troy Limited 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Registration Statement on Form S-8, File Number 333-67369, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 17, 1998).

10.12†

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending August 31, 1999 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 15, 1999 (the “August 1999 10-Q”)).

 

113



Table of Contents

 

10.13†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy Limited 1995 Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to the August 1999 10-Q).

10.14

Master License Agreement dated October 21, 2002, between The Procter & Gamble Company and Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados) (Confidential treatment has been requested with respect to certain portions of this exhibit. Omitted portions have been filed separately with the Commission).

10.15†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy 1997 Cash Bonus Performance Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to Appendix D of Helen of Troy Limited’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 27, 2008 (the “2008 Proxy Statement”)).

10.16

Credit Agreement, dated June 1, 2004, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and the other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 3, 2004).

10.17

Guaranty, dated June 1, 2004, made by Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados), Hot Nevada, Inc., Helen of Troy Nevada Corporation, Helen of Troy Texas Corporation, Idelle Labs Ltd. and OXO International Ltd., in favor of Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders, pursuant to the Credit Agreement, dated June 1, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 3, 2004).

10.18

Note Purchase Agreement, dated June 29, 2004, by and among Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados) and the purchasers listed in Schedule A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on July 2, 2004).

10.19†

Amendment to Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 26, 2005).

10.20

Second Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of September 23, 2005, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended November 30, 2005 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission  on January 19, 2006 (the “November 2005 10-Q”).

10.21†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy Limited 1998 Stock Option and Restricted Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A of Helen of Troy Limited’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, File Number 001-14669, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 15, 2005).

10.22†

Form of Helen of Troy Limited Nonstatutory Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 of Helen of Troy Limited’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended February 29, 2008, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 13, 2008 (the “2008 10-K”).

10.23†

Form of Helen of Troy Limited Incentive Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of the 2008 10-K).

10.24

Third Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2005, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the November 2005 10-Q).

10.25

First Amendment to Guarantee Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2005, among Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados), HOT Nevada, Inc., Helen of Troy Nevada Corporation, Helen of Troy Texas Corporation, Idelle Labs Ltd., OXO International Ltd. and Bank of America, N.A. (as Guaranteed party) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the November 2005 10-Q).

10.26†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.27†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Non-Employee Directors Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix C to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.28†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix B to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.29

Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of December 15, 2008 among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 24, 2008).

 

114



Table of Contents

 

10.30†

Second Amendment to Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 6, 2009).

10.31†

Form of Restricted Stock Agreement for the Company’s 2008 Non-Employee Directors Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 26, 2009).

21*

Subsidiaries of the Registrant.

23.1*

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, Grant Thornton LLP.

31.1*

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

31.2*

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

32*

Joint certification of the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

 

115



Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

HELEN OF TROY LIMITED

 

 

 

By: /s/ Gerald J. Rubin

 

Gerald J. Rubin, Chairman,

 

Chief Executive Officer and Director

 

May 13, 2010

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Exchange Act, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

/s/ Gerald J. Rubin

/s/ Thomas J. Benson

Gerald J. Rubin

Thomas J. Benson

Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer, President, Director and Principal Executive Officer

Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer

May 13, 2010

May 13, 2010

 

 

 

/s/ Richard J. Oppenheim

/s/ Gary B. Abromovitz

Richard J. Oppenheim

Gary B. Abromovitz

Financial Controller and Principal Accounting Officer

Director, Deputy Chairman of the Board

May 13, 2010

May 13, 2010

 

 

/s/ John B. Butterworth

/s/ Timothy F. Meeker

John B. Butterworth

Timothy F. Meeker

Director

Director

May 13, 2010

May 13, 2010

 

 

/s/ Byron H. Rubin

/s/ Stanlee N. Rubin

Byron H. Rubin

Stanlee N. Rubin

Director

Director

May 13, 2010

May 13, 2010

 

 

/s/ William F. Susetka

/s/ Adolpho R. Telles

William F. Susetka

Adolpho R. Telles

Director

Director

May 13, 2010

May 13, 2010

 

 

/s/ Darren G. Woody

 

Darren G. Woody

 

Director

 

May 13, 2010

 

 

116



Table of Contents

 

INDEX TO EXHIBITS

 

The exhibit numbers succeeded by an asterisk (*) indicate exhibits physically filed with this Form 10-K.  All other exhibit numbers indicate exhibits filed by incorporation by reference.  Exhibit numbers succeeded by a cross (†) are management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements.

 

3.1

Memorandum of Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, File No. 33-73594, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 30, 1993 (the “1993 S-4”)).

3.2

Bye-Laws, as Amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending August 31, 2007, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 10, 2007).

10.1†

Form of Directors’ and Executive Officers’ Indemnity Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the 1993 S-4).

10.2

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) North American Appliances License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending November 30, 1992 (the “November 1992 10-Q”)).

10.3

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) International Appliances License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.4

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) North American Comb and Brush License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.5

Revlon Consumer Products Corporation (RCPC) International Comb and Brush License Agreement dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to the November 1992 10-Q).

10.6

First Amendment to RCPC North America Appliance License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for the year Ending February 28, 1993 (the “1993 10-K”).

10.7

First Amendment to RCPC North America Comb and Brush License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Helen of Troy Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission for the year Ending February 28, 1993 (the “1993 10-K”).

10.8

First Amendment to RCPC International Appliance License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to the 1993 10-K).

10.9

First Amendment to RCPC International Comb and Brush License Agreement, dated September 30, 1992 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to the 1993 10-K).

10.10

Guaranteed Senior Notes and $40,000,000 Guaranteed Senior Note Facility (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending November 30, 1996 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 14, 1997).

10.11†

Helen of Troy Limited 1998 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Registration Statement on Form S-8, File Number 333-67369, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on November 17, 1998).

10.12†

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ending August 31, 1999 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 15, 1999 (the “August 1999 10-Q”)).

10.13†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy Limited 1995 Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to the August 1999 10-Q).

10.14

Master License Agreement dated October 21, 2002, between The Procter & Gamble Company and Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados) (Confidential treatment has been requested with respect to certain portions of this exhibit. Omitted portions have been filed separately with the Commission).

 

117



Table of Contents

 

10.15†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy 1997 Cash Bonus Performance Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to Appendix D of Helen of Troy Limited’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 27, 2008 (the “2008 Proxy Statement”)).

10.16

Credit Agreement, dated June 1, 2004, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and the other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 3, 2004).

10.17

Guaranty, dated June 1, 2004, made by Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados), Hot Nevada, Inc., Helen of Troy Nevada Corporation, Helen of Troy Texas Corporation, Idelle Labs Ltd. and OXO International Ltd., in favor of Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders, pursuant to the Credit Agreement, dated June 1, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 3, 2004).

10.18

Note Purchase Agreement, dated June 29, 2004, by and among Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados) and the purchasers listed in Schedule A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on July 2, 2004).

10.19†

Amendment to Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 26, 2005).

10.20

Second Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of September 23, 2005, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Helen of Troy Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended November 30, 2005 filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission  on January 19, 2006 (the “November 2005 10-Q”).

10.21†

Amended and Restated Helen of Troy Limited 1998 Stock Option and Restricted Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A of Helen of Troy Limited’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, File Number 001-14669, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on June 15, 2005).

10.22†

Form of Helen of Troy Limited Nonstatutory Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 of Helen of Troy Limited’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended February 29, 2008, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 13, 2008 (the “2008 10-K”).

10.23†

Form of Helen of Troy Limited Incentive Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of the 2008 10-K).

10.24

Third Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2005, among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the November 2005 10-Q).

10.25

First Amendment to Guarantee Agreement, dated as of November 15, 2005, among Helen of Troy Limited (Bermuda), Helen of Troy Limited (Barbados), HOT Nevada, Inc., Helen of Troy Nevada Corporation, Helen of Troy Texas Corporation, Idelle Labs Ltd., OXO International Ltd. and Bank of America, N.A. (as Guaranteed party) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the November 2005 10-Q).

10.26†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.27†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Non-Employee Directors Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix C to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.28†

Helen of Troy Limited 2008 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix B to the 2008 Proxy Statement).

10.29

Fourth Amendment to Credit Agreement, dated as of December 15, 2008 among Helen of Troy L.P., Helen of Troy Limited, Bank of America, N.A. and other lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 24, 2008).

10.30†

Second Amendment to Employment Agreement between Helen of Troy Limited and Gerald J. Rubin, dated March 1, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 6, 2009).

 

118



Table of Contents

 

10.31†

Form of Restricted Stock Agreement for the Company’s 2008 Non-Employee Directors Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 26, 2009).

21*

Subsidiaries of the Registrant.

23.1*

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, Grant Thornton LLP.

31.1*

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

31.2*

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

32*

Joint certification of the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.

 

119